blob: 371fd8a446314634ee4f49620e98fc51c464ba62 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaud0089302020-04-17 14:19:38 +02007 2020/04/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
574. Proxies
584.1. Proxy keywords matrix
594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
60
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100615. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200625.1. Bind options
635.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200645.3. Server DNS resolution
655.3.1. Global overview
665.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020067
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100686. Cache
696.1. Limitation
706.2. Setup
716.2.1. Cache section
726.2.2. Proxy section
73
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200747. Using ACLs and fetching samples
757.1. ACL basics
767.1.1. Matching booleans
777.1.2. Matching integers
787.1.3. Matching strings
797.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
807.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
817.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
827.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
837.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200847.3.1. Converters
857.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
867.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
877.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
887.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
897.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Fauletba3c68f2020-04-01 16:27:05 +0200907.3.7. Fetching health-check samples
917.3.8. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093
948. Logging
958.1. Log levels
968.2. Log formats
978.2.1. Default log format
988.2.2. TCP log format
998.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001008.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001018.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001028.3. Advanced logging options
1038.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1048.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1058.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1068.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1078.4. Timing events
1088.5. Session state at disconnection
1098.6. Non-printable characters
1108.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1118.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1128.9. Examples of logs
113
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001149. Supported filters
1159.1. Trace
1169.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001179.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001189.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001199.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200120
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012110. FastCGI applications
12210.1. Setup
12310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12410.1.2. Proxy section
12510.1.3. Example
12610.2. Default parameters
12710.3. Limitations
128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129
1301. Quick reminder about HTTP
131----------------------------
132
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
135on almost anything found in the contents.
136
137However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
138formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
139correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
140
141
1421.1. The HTTP transaction model
143-------------------------------
144
145The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100146to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100147from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
148connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149will involve a new connection :
150
151 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
152
153In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
154establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
155by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
156length.
157
158Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
159to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
160however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
161response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
162header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
167power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
168but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
173second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
174page :
175
176 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
177
178This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
179latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
180correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
181the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100182server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100184The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
185time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
186are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
187parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
188carry the stream identifier.
189
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
191connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
192leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
194processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
195waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200196
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200197HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
199 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100200 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100201 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200202 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100203
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100204For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
205the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100206server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
207is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
208servers.
209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210
2111.2. HTTP request
212-----------------
213
214First, let's consider this HTTP request :
215
216 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100217 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
219 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
220 3 User-agent: my small browser
221 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
222 5 Accept: image/png
223
224
2251.2.1. The Request line
226-----------------------
227
228Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
229
230 - a METHOD : GET
231 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
232 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
233
234All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
235which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
236followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
237is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
238desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
239the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
240
241The URI itself can have several forms :
242
243 - A "relative URI" :
244
245 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
246
247 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
248 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
249
250 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
251
252 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
253
254 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
255 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
256 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
257 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
258 must accept this form too.
259
260 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
261 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
262 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100263
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200264 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
265 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
266 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
267 other protocols too.
268
269In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
270mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
271on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
272It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
273specific to the language, framework or application in use.
274
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100275HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100276assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
278received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
279processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
280as well as in server logs.
281
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200282
2831.2.2. The request headers
284--------------------------
285
286The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
287beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
288an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
289Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
290values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
291encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
292the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
293define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
294
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100295Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200296their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100297"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
298as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299
300The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
301that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
302is one valid form of empty line.
303
304Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
305headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
306about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
307application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
308
309Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000310 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
312 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
313 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
314
315
3161.3. HTTP response
317------------------
318
319An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
320messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
321
322 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100323 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200324 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
325 2 Content-length: 350
326 3 Content-Type: text/html
327
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200328As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
329codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
330response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100331continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
332the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
333following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
334sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
335(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
336correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
337such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
338state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
339over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
340if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
341information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200343
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003441.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345------------------------
346
347Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
348
349 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
350 - a status code : 200
351 - a reason : OK
352
353The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
355 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
356 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
357 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
358 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000360Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100361"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
363messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
364or "Authentication Required".
365
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100366HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
368 Code When / reason
369 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
370 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100373 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 400 for an invalid or too large request
376 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
377 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200378 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100379 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200380 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100381 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
382 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200383 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
384 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
385 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200386 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200387 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
388 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
389 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
390
391The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3924.2).
393
394
3951.3.2. The response headers
396---------------------------
397
398Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
399the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
400details.
401
402
4032. Configuring HAProxy
404----------------------
405
4062.1. Configuration file format
407------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200408
409HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
410
411 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
412 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
413 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
414 "frontend" and "backend".
415
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100416The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
417referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200418delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100419
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200420
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004212.2. Quoting and escaping
422-------------------------
423
424HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
425many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
426with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
427single quotes.
428
429If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
430them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
431escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
432
433Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
434
435 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
436 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
437 \\ to use a backslash
438 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
439 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
440
441Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
442the interpretation of:
443
444 space as a parameter separator
445 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
446 # hash as a comment start
447
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200448Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
449-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
450backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
451
452Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200453quoting.
454
455Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
456nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
457
458Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
459equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
460
461 Example:
462 # those are equivalents:
463 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
464 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
465 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
467 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
468
469 # those are equivalents:
470 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
473 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
474
475
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004762.3. Environment variables
477--------------------------
478
479HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
480interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
481configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
482optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
483shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
484underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
485
486 Example:
487
488 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
489
490 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
491
492 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
493
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200494Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
495file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200496
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200497* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
498 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
499
500* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
501 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
502 directory.
503
504* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
505
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500506* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200507 processes, separated by semicolons.
508
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500509* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200510 CLI, separated by semicolons.
511
512See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200513
5142.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200515----------------
516
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100517Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100518values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
519otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
520numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
521for every keyword. Supported units are :
522
523 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
524 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
525 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
526 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
527 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
528 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
529
530
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005312.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200532-------------
533
534 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
535 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
536 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
537 global
538 daemon
539 maxconn 256
540
541 defaults
542 mode http
543 timeout connect 5000ms
544 timeout client 50000ms
545 timeout server 50000ms
546
547 frontend http-in
548 bind *:80
549 default_backend servers
550
551 backend servers
552 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
553
554
555 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
556 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
557 global
558 daemon
559 maxconn 256
560
561 defaults
562 mode http
563 timeout connect 5000ms
564 timeout client 50000ms
565 timeout server 50000ms
566
567 listen http-in
568 bind *:80
569 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
570
571
572Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
573
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100574 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200575
576
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005773. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200578--------------------
579
580Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
581are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
582of them have command-line equivalents.
583
584The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
585
586 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200587 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200588 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200589 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200592 - description
593 - deviceatlas-json-file
594 - deviceatlas-log-level
595 - deviceatlas-separator
596 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900597 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598 - gid
599 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100600 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200601 - h1-case-adjust
602 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100603 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100604 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100605 - issuers-chain-path
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200607 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100608 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200609 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100610 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200611 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200612 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200613 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200614 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200615 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100616 - presetenv
617 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200618 - uid
619 - ulimit-n
620 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200621 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100622 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200623 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200624 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200625 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200626 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200627 - ssl-default-bind-options
628 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200629 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200630 - ssl-default-server-options
631 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100632 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200633 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100634 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100635 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100636 - 51degrees-data-file
637 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200638 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200639 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200640 - wurfl-data-file
641 - wurfl-information-list
642 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200643 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100644 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100645
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200646 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100647 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200648 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200649 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200650 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100651 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100652 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100653 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200654 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200655 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200656 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200657 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200658 - noepoll
659 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000660 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200661 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100662 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300663 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000664 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100665 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200666 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200667 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200668 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000669 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000670 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200671 - tune.buffers.limit
672 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200673 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200674 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100675 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200676 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200677 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200678 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100679 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200680 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200681 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100682 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100683 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100684 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100685 - tune.lua.session-timeout
686 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200687 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100688 - tune.maxaccept
689 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200690 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200691 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200692 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100693 - tune.rcvbuf.client
694 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100695 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200696 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100697 - tune.sndbuf.client
698 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100699 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100700 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200701 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100702 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200703 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200704 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100705 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200706 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100707 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200708 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
709 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
710 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100711 - tune.zlib.memlevel
712 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100713
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200714 * Debugging
715 - debug
716 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200717 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200718
719
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007203.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200721------------------------------------
722
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200723ca-base <dir>
724 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100725 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
726 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
727 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200728
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200729chroot <jail dir>
730 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
731 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
732 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
733 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
734 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100735 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100736
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100737cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
738 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
739 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
740 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
741 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
742 set. These sets have the format
743
744 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
745
746 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100747 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100748 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
749 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100750 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
751 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100752 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100753 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100754 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100755 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100756 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
757 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
758 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
759 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100760
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100761 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
762 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
763 on the machine's word size.
764
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100765 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100766 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
767 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
768 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
769 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
770 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
771 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100772
773 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100774 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
775
776 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
777 # first 4 CPUs
778
779 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
780 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
781 # word size.
782
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100783 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100784 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100785 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
786 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
787 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
788
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100789 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
790 # and so on.
791 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
792 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
793 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
794
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100795 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100796 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
797 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
798 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
799
800 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
801 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
802 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
803
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100804 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
805 # and a thread range.
806 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
807 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
808 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
809
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200810crt-base <dir>
811 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100812 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
813 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200814
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200815daemon
816 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
817 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100818 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
819 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200821deviceatlas-json-file <path>
822 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100823 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200824
825deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100826 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200827 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
828
829deviceatlas-separator <char>
830 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
831 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
832
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100833deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200834 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
835 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
836 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100837
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900838external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100839 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
840 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100841 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
842 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
843 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
844 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
845 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900846
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200847gid <number>
848 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
849 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
850 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100851 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
852 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200853 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100854
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100855group <group name>
856 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
857 See also "gid" and "user".
858
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100859hard-stop-after <time>
860 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
861
862 Arguments :
863 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
864 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
865 SIGUSR1 signal.
866
867 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
868 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
869 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
870
871 Example:
872 global
873 hard-stop-after 30s
874
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200875h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
876 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
877 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
878 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
879 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500880 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200881 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
882 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
883 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
884 specified in a proxy.
885
886 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
887 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
888 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
889 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
890 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
891 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
892 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
893
894 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
895 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
896 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
897 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
898 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
899
900 Example:
901 global
902 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
903
904 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
905 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
906
907h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
908 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
909 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
910 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
911 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
912 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
913 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
914 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
915 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
916
917 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
918 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
919 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
920
921 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
922 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
923
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100924insecure-fork-wanted
925 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
926 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
927 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
928 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
929 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
930 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
931 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
932 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
933 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
934 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
935 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
936 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
937 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
938 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
939 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
940 disable it.
941
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100942insecure-setuid-wanted
943 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
944 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
945 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
946 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
947 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
948 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
949 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
950 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
951 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
952 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
953 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
954 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
955 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
956 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
957
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100958issuers-chain-path <dir>
959 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
960 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
961 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
962 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
963 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
964 "issuers-chain-path".
965 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
966 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
967 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
968 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
969 will share the chain in memory.
970
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200971log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
972 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100973 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100974 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100975 configured with "log global".
976
977 <address> can be one of:
978
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100979 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100980 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
981 port).
982
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100983 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
984 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
985 port).
986
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100987 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100988 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
989 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100990 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100991
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100992 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
993 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
994 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
995 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
996 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
997 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
998 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
999 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1000 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1001 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1002 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1003 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1004 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1005 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001006 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1007 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001008
1009 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1010 "fd@2", see above.
1011
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001012 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1013 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1014 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1015 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1016 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1017
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001018 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1019 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001020
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001021 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1022 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1023 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1024 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1025 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1026 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1027 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1028 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1029 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1030 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001031 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1032 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001033
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001034 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1035 one of the following :
1036
1037 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1038 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1039
1040 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1041 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1042
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001043 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1044 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1045 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1046 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1047 logger consumes.
1048
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001049 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1050 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1051 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1052 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1053
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001054 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1055 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1056 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1057 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1058 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1059
1060 <sample_size>
1061 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1062 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1063 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1064 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1065 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1066
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001067 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001069 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1070 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1071 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1072
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001073 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1074 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1075 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1076 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001077
1078 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001079 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1080 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1081 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1082 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1083 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1084 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001085
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001086 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001087
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001088log-send-hostname [<string>]
1089 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1090 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1091 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1092 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1093 the logs.
1094
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001095log-tag <string>
1096 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1097 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1098 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001099 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001100
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001101lua-load <file>
1102 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1103 used multiple times.
1104
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001105lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1106 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1107 variable.
1108 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1109 to "path".
1110
1111 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1112 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1113 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1114 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1115 will be checked earlier.
1116
1117 As an example by specifying the following path:
1118
1119 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1120 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1121
1122 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1123 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1124 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1125 paths if that does not exist either.
1126
1127 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1128 documentation.
1129
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001130master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001131 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1132 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1133 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001134 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001135 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1136 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001137 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1138 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1139 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1140 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1141 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001142
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001143 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001144
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001145mworker-max-reloads <number>
1146 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001147 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001148 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1149 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1150 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1151
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001152nbproc <number>
1153 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1154 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1155 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001156 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1157 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001158 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1159 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001160
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001161nbthread <number>
1162 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001163 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1164 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1165 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1166 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1167 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001168 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1169 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1170 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1171 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1172 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1173 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1174 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001175
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001176pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001177 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001178 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1179 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1180
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001181presetenv <name> <value>
1182 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1183 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1184 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1185 and "unsetenv".
1186
1187resetenv [<name> ...]
1188 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1189 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1190 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1191 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1192 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1193 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1194 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1195 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1196
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001197stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001198 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1199 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1200 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1201 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1202 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1203 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001204 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001205 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1206 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1207 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1208 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001209
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001210server-state-base <directory>
1211 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001212 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1213 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001214
1215server-state-file <file>
1216 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1217 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1218 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1219 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1220 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1221 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1222 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1223 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001224 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1225 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001226
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001227setenv <name> <value>
1228 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1229 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1230 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1231 and "unsetenv".
1232
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001233set-dumpable
1234 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001235 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1236 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1237 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1238 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1239 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1240 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1241 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1242 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1243 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1244 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1245 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1246 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1247 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1248 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1249 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1250 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1251 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001252
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001253ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1254 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1255 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001256 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001257 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001258 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1259 information and recommendations see e.g.
1260 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1261 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1262 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1263 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001264
1265ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1266 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1267 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1268 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1269 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1270 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001271 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1272 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1273 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001274 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001275
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001276ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1277 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1278 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1279 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1280 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1281 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1282
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001283ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1284 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1285 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1286 keyword to see available options.
1287
1288 Example:
1289 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001290 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001291
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001292ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1293 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1294 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001295 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001296 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001297 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1298 information and recommendations see e.g.
1299 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1300 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1301 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1302 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1303 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001304
1305ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1306 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1307 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1308 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1309 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1310 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001311 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1312 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1313 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1314 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001315
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001316ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1317 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1318 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1319 keyword to see available options.
1320
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001321ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1322 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1323 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1324 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001325 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001326 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001327 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1328 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1329 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1330 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001331 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1332 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1333 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1334
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001335ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001336 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1337 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1338
1339 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1340 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1341 optimize the startup time.
1342
1343 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1344 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1345 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1346
1347 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001348 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001349
1350 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1351 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1352 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1353 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1354 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1355 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001356 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specify both the ECDSA
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001357 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1358
1359 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1360
1361 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1362
1363 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1364 not provided in the PEM file.
1365
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001366 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1367 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1368
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001369 The default behavior is "all".
1370
1371 Example:
1372 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1373 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1374 ssl-load-extra-files none
1375
1376 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1377
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001378ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1379 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1380 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1381 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1382
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001383ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
1384 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the enchor for chain validation: as a
1385 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1386 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1387 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1388 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1389 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1390 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
1391 bits does not need it.
1392
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001393stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1394 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1395 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1396 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001397 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001398 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001399
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001400 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1401 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1402 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001403
1404stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1405 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1406 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001407 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001408
1409stats maxconn <connections>
1410 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1411 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1412
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001413uid <number>
1414 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1415 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1416 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1417 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1418
1419ulimit-n <number>
1420 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1421 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1422 option.
1423
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001424unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1425 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1426
1427 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1428 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1429 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1430 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1431 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1432 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1433 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1434 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1435 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1436 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1437
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001438unsetenv [<name> ...]
1439 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1440 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1441 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1442 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1443 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1444 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1445 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1446
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001447user <user name>
1448 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1449 See also "uid" and "group".
1450
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001451node <name>
1452 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1453
1454 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1455 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1456 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1457 traffic.
1458
1459description <text>
1460 Add a text that describes the instance.
1461
1462 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1463 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1464 "<" and ">" characters.
1465
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100146651degrees-data-file <file path>
1467 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001468 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001469
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001470 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001471 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1472
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000147351degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001474 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1475 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1476 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1477
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001478 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001479 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1480
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200148151degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001482 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1483 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1484
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001485 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1486 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1487
148851degrees-cache-size <number>
1489 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1490 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1491 By default, this cache is disabled.
1492
1493 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001494 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1495
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001496wurfl-data-file <file path>
1497 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1498 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1499
1500 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1501 with USE_WURFL=1.
1502
1503wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1504 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1505 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1506 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1507
1508 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1509
1510 Valid WURFL properties are:
1511 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1512
1513 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1514 device.
1515
1516 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1517 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1518
1519 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1520 particular web request.
1521
1522 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1523 used Libwurfl API version.
1524
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001525 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1526 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1527
1528 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1529 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1530
1531 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1532
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001533 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1534 with USE_WURFL=1.
1535
1536wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1537 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1538 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1539
1540 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1541 with USE_WURFL=1.
1542
1543wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1544 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1545 thus before the chroot.
1546
1547 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1548 with USE_WURFL=1.
1549
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001550wurfl-cache-size <size>
1551 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1552 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001553 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001554 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001555
1556 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1557 with USE_WURFL=1.
1558
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001559strict-limits
1560 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1561 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1562 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1563 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1564 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1565 keyword.
1566
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015673.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001568-----------------------
1569
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001570busy-polling
1571 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1572 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1573 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1574 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1575 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1576 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1577 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1578 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1579 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1580 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1581 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1582 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1583 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1584 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1585 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1586 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1587 "poll" pollers.
1588
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001589 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1590 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1591 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1592
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001593max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1594 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1595 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1596 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1597 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1598 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1599 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1600 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1601 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1602
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001603maxconn <number>
1604 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1605 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1606 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001607 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1608 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1609 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1610 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001611 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1612 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1613 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1614 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1615 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1616 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001617
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001618maxconnrate <number>
1619 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1620 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1621 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1622 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1623 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1624 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1625 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1626 fairness.
1627
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001628maxcomprate <number>
1629 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001630 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001631 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1632 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1633 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001634 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001635 default value.
1636
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001637maxcompcpuusage <number>
1638 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1639 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1640 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1641 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1642 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1643 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1644 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1645 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1646
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001647maxpipes <number>
1648 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1649 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1650 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1651 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1652 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1653 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1654
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001655maxsessrate <number>
1656 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1657 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1658 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1659 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1660 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1661 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1662 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1663 fairness.
1664
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001665maxsslconn <number>
1666 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1667 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1668 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1669 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1670 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1671 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1672 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001673 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1674 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1675 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1676 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1677 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1678 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1679 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001680
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001681maxsslrate <number>
1682 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1683 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1684 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1685 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1686 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1687 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1688 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1689 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1690 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1691 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1692
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001693maxzlibmem <number>
1694 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1695 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1696 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001697 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1698 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1699 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1700
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001701noepoll
1702 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1703 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001704 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001705
1706nokqueue
1707 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1708 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1709 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1710
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001711noevports
1712 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1713 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1714 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1715 also "nopoll".
1716
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001717nopoll
1718 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1719 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001720 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001721 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1722 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001723
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001724nosplice
1725 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001726 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001727 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001728 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001729 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1730 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1731 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1732 "option splice-response".
1733
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001734nogetaddrinfo
1735 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1736 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1737
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001738noreuseport
1739 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1740 command line argument "-dR".
1741
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001742profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1743 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1744 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1745 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1746 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001747 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001748 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1749 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1750 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1751 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1752
1753 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1754 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1755 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1756 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1757 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001758 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1759 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1760 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1761 CLI.
1762
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001763spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001764 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1765 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1766 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1767 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1768 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1769 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001770
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001771ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001772 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001773 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001774 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1775 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1776 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1777 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1778 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001779 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1780 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001781 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1782 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1783 openssl configuration file uses:
1784 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1785
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001786ssl-mode-async
1787 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001788 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001789 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1790 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1791 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001792 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001793 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001794
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001795tune.buffers.limit <number>
1796 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1797 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1798 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1799 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1800 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001801 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001802 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1803 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1804 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1805 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1806 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1807 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1808 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1809 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1810 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1811
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001812tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1813 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1814 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1815 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1816 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1817
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001818tune.bufsize <number>
1819 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1820 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1821 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1822 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1823 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1824 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1825 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001826 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1827 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1828 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001829 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001830 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1831 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1832 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001833
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001834tune.chksize <number>
1835 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1836 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1837 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1838 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1839 checks whenever possible.
1840
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001841tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1842 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1843 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1844 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1845 this value. The default value is 1.
1846
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001847tune.fail-alloc
1848 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1849 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1850 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1851 gracefully.
1852
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001853tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1854 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1855 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1856 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1857 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1858 change it.
1859
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001860tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1861 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001862 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1863 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001864 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1865 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1866 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1867 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1868 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1869
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001870tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1871 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1872 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1873 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1874 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1875 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1876 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1877 recommended not to change this value.
1878
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001879tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1880 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1881 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1882 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1883 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1884 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1885 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1886 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1887
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001888tune.http.cookielen <number>
1889 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1890 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1891 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1892 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1893 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1894 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1895 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1896 to change this value.
1897
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001898tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001899 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1900 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001901 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001902 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001903 configuration directives too.
1904 The default value is 1024.
1905
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001906tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1907 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1908 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1909 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1910 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1911 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1912 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001913 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1914 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1915 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001916
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001917tune.idletimer <timeout>
1918 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1919 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1920 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1921 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1922 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1923 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001924 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001925 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001926 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1927
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001928tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1929 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1930 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1931 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1932 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1933 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1934 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1935 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1936 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1937 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1938
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001939tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1940 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001941 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001942 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1943 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001944 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001945 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1946 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1947
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001948tune.lua.maxmem
1949 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1950 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1951 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1952 memory.
1953
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001954tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1955 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001956 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1957 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001958 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001959
1960tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1961 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1962 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1963 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1964 check servers.
1965
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001966tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1967 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1968 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1969 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001970 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001971
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001972tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001973 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1974 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1975 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1976 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1977 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1978 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1979 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1980 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1981 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1982 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001983
1984tune.maxpollevents <number>
1985 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1986 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1987 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1988 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1989 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1990
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001991tune.maxrewrite <number>
1992 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1993 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1994 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1995 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1996 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1997 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1998 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1999 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2000 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2001 bufsize.
2002
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002003tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2004 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2005 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2006 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2007 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2008 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2009 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2010 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2011 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2012 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002013 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2014 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002015 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2016 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2017 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2018 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2019 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2020 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2021 setting this parameter to 0.
2022
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002023tune.pipesize <number>
2024 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2025 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2026 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2027 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2028 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2029 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2030
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002031tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2032 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2033 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2034 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2035 default is 20.
2036
2037tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2038 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2039 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2040 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2041 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2042 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2043 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002044 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002045
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002046tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2047tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2048 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2049 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2050 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002051 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002052 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002053 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2054 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2055
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002056tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002057 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002058 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2059 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2060 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2061 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2062
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002063tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002064 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002065 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
2066 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
2067
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002068tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2069tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2070 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2071 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2072 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002073 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002074 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002075 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2076 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2077 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2078 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2079 notifying haproxy again.
2080
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002081tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002082 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2083 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2084 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002085 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002086 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002087 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002088 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2089 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2090 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002091 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2092 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002093
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002094tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002095 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002096 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2097 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2098 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2099 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2100 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2101
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002102tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2103 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002104 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002105 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2106 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2107 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2108 being used for too long.
2109
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002110tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2111 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2112 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2113 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2114 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2115 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2116 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2117 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2118 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2119 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2120 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002121 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002122 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002123
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002124tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2125 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2126 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2127 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2128 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2129 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
2130 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2131 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002132 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2133 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002134
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002135tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2136 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2137 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2138 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2139 1000 entries.
2140
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002141tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2142 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2143 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2144 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2145
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002146tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002147tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002148tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2149tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2150tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002151 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2152 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2153 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2154 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2155 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2156 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2157 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2158 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002159
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002160 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2161 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2162 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2163 all available space is consumed.
2164 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2165 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2166 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002167
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002168tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2169 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002170 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002171 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002172 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002173 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2174
2175tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2176 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2177 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002178 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2179 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002180
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021813.3. Debugging
2182--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002183
Willy Tarreau1b857852020-02-25 11:27:22 +01002184debug (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002185 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2186 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2187 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2188 system startup.
2189
2190quiet
2191 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2192 line argument "-q".
2193
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002194zero-warning
2195 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2196 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2197 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2198 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2199 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2200 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2201
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002202
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022033.4. Userlists
2204--------------
2205It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2206http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2207it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2208
2209userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002210 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002211 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2212
2213group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002214 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002215 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2216 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2217
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002218user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2219 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002220 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2221 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002222 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2223 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2224 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2225 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002226
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002227 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2228 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2229 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2230 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2231 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2232 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2233 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2234 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2235 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002236
2237 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002238 userlist L1
2239 group G1 users tiger,scott
2240 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002241
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002242 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2243 user scott insecure-password elgato
2244 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002245
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002246 userlist L2
2247 group G1
2248 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002249
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002250 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2251 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2252 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002253
2254 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002255
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002256
22573.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002258----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002259It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2260several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2261instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2262values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2263automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2264In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2265using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2266tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2267reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2268Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2269that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2270each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002271
2272peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002273 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002274 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2275
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002276bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2277 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2278 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2279
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002280disabled
2281 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2282 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2283 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2284
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002285default-bind [param*]
2286 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2287
2288default-server [param*]
2289 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2290
2291 Arguments:
2292 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2293 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2294 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2295 details.
2296
2297
2298 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2299
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002300enable
2301 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2302
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002303log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2304 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2305 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2306 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2307 more details.
2308
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002309peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002310 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2311 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2312 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2313 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2314 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2315 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2316
2317 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2318 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2319
2320 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2321 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2322 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2323 across all peers.
2324
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002325 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2326 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002327
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002328 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2329 "server" keyword explanation below).
2330
2331server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002332 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002333 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2334 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2335 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2336 of this "peers" section).
2337 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2338
2339
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002340 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002341 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002342 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002343 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2344 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2345 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002346
2347 backend mybackend
2348 mode tcp
2349 balance roundrobin
2350 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2351 stick on src
2352
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002353 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2354 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002355
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002356 Example:
2357 peers mypeers
2358 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2359 default-server ssl verify none
2360 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2361 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002362
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002363
2364table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2365 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2366
2367 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2368 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002369 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002370 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2371 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2372 "stick-table" keyword).
2373
2374 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2375 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2376 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2377 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2378 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2379 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2380 of the stick-table name as follows:
2381
2382 peers mypeers
2383 peer A ...
2384 peer B ...
2385 table t1 ...
2386
2387 frontend fe1
2388 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2389
2390 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2391 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2392
2393 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2394 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2395 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2396 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2397 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2398 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2399 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2400
2401 peers mypeers
2402 peer A ...
2403 peer B ...
2404 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2405
2406 backend t1
2407 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2408
2409 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2410 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2411 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2412
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090024133.6. Mailers
2414------------
2415It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2416If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2417in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2418
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002419mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002420 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2421 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2422
2423mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2424 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2425
2426 Example:
2427 mailers mymailers
2428 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2429 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2430
2431 backend mybackend
2432 mode tcp
2433 balance roundrobin
2434
2435 email-alert mailers mymailers
2436 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2437 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2438
2439 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2440 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2441
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002442timeout mail <time>
2443 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2444 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2445 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2446 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2447
2448 Example:
2449 mailers mymailers
2450 timeout mail 20s
2451 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002452
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020024533.7. Programs
2454-------------
2455In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2456master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2457managed the same way as the workers.
2458
2459During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2460sequence as a worker:
2461
2462 - the master is re-executed
2463 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2464 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2465 instance of the program
2466
2467During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2468
2469program <name>
2470 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2471 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2472 the management guide).
2473
2474command <command> [arguments*]
2475 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2476 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2477 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2478 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2479
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002480user <user name>
2481 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2482 See also "group".
2483
2484group <group name>
2485 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2486 See also "user".
2487
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002488option start-on-reload
2489no option start-on-reload
2490 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2491 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2492 program section.
2493
2494
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010024953.8. HTTP-errors
2496----------------
2497
2498It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2499imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2500several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2501
2502http-errors <name>
2503 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2504 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2505
2506errorfile <code> <file>
2507 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2508
2509 Arguments :
2510 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2511 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429,
2512 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2513
2514 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2515 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2516 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2517 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2518 before any chroot is performed.
2519
2520 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2521
2522 Example:
2523 http-errors website-1
2524 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2525 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2526 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2527
2528 http-errors website-2
2529 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2530 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2531 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2532
2533
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025344. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002535----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002536
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002537Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002538 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002539 - frontend <name>
2540 - backend <name>
2541 - listen <name>
2542
2543A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2544its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2545section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002546section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002547
2548A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2549connections.
2550
2551A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2552to forward incoming connections.
2553
2554A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2555parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2556
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002557All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2558'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2559case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2560
2561Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2562logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2563proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2564However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2565name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2566
2567Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2568and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002569bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002570protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2571modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2572arbitrary criteria.
2573
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002574In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2575a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002576the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002577
2578 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2579 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2580 between responses and new requests.
2581
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002582 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2583 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2584 client-facing connection remains open.
2585
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002586 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2587 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002588
2589The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2590frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2591following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002592weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002593
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002594 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002595
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002596 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2597 ----+-----+-----+----
2598 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2599 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002600 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2601 ----+-----+-----+----
2602 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002603
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002604
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026064.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2607--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002608
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002609The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2610limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2611they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2612limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002613marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002614option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002615and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2616with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2617specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002618
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002619
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002620 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2621------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2622acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002623backlog X X X -
2624balance X - X X
2625bind - X X -
2626bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002627capture cookie - X X -
2628capture request header - X X -
2629capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002630compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002631cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002632declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002633default-server X - X X
2634default_backend X X X -
2635description - X X X
2636disabled X X X X
2637dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002638email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002639email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002640email-alert mailers X X X X
2641email-alert myhostname X X X X
2642email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002643enabled X X X X
2644errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002645errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002646errorloc X X X X
2647errorloc302 X X X X
2648-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2649errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002650force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002651filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002652fullconn X - X X
2653grace X X X X
2654hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002655http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002656http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002657http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002658http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002659http-check expect X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002660http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002661http-check set-var X - X X
2662http-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002663http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002664http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002665http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002666http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002667id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002668ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002669load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002670log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002671log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002672log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002673log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002674max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002675maxconn X X X -
2676mode X X X X
2677monitor fail - X X -
2678monitor-net X X X -
2679monitor-uri X X X -
2680option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2681option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2682option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2683option allbackups (*) X - X X
2684option checkcache (*) X - X X
2685option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2686option contstats (*) X X X -
2687option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2688option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002689-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2690option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002691option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2692option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002693option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002694option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002695option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002696option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002697option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002698option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2699option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2700option httpchk X - X X
2701option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002702option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002703option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002704option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002705option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002706option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002707option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2708option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2709option logasap (*) X X X -
2710option mysql-check X - X X
2711option nolinger (*) X X X X
2712option originalto X X X X
2713option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002714option pgsql-check X - X X
2715option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002716option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002717option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002718option smtpchk X - X X
2719option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2720option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2721option splice-request (*) X X X X
2722option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002723option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002724option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2725option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2726-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002727option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002728option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2729option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2730option tcpka X X X X
2731option tcplog X X X X
2732option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002733external-check command X - X X
2734external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002735persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2736rate-limit sessions X X X -
2737redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002738-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002739retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002740retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002741server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002742server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002743server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002744source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002745stats admin - X X X
2746stats auth X X X X
2747stats enable X X X X
2748stats hide-version X X X X
2749stats http-request - X X X
2750stats realm X X X X
2751stats refresh X X X X
2752stats scope X X X X
2753stats show-desc X X X X
2754stats show-legends X X X X
2755stats show-node X X X X
2756stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002757-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2758stick match - - X X
2759stick on - - X X
2760stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002761stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002762stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002763tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002764tcp-check connect X - X X
2765tcp-check expect X - X X
2766tcp-check send X - X X
2767tcp-check send-binary X - X X
2768tcp-check set-var X - X X
2769tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002770tcp-request connection - X X -
2771tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002772tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002773tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002774tcp-response content - - X X
2775tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002776timeout check X - X X
2777timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002778timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002779timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002780timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2781timeout http-request X X X X
2782timeout queue X - X X
2783timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002784timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002785timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002786timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002787transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002788unique-id-format X X X -
2789unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002790use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002791use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002792use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002793------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2794 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002795
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002796
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027974.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2798---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002799
2800This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2801
2802
2803acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2804 Declare or complete an access list.
2805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2806 no | yes | yes | yes
2807 Example:
2808 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2809 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2810 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2811
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002812 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002813
2814
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002815backlog <conns>
2816 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2818 yes | yes | yes | no
2819 Arguments :
2820 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2821 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002822 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002823
2824 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2825 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2826 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2827 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2828 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2829 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2830 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2831 backlog parameter.
2832
2833 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2834 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2835 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2836
2837 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2838
2839
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002840balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002841balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002842 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2844 yes | no | yes | yes
2845 Arguments :
2846 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2847 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2848 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2849 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2850
2851 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2852 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2853 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2854 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002855 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002856 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002857 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2858 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2859 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2860 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2861 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2862 it, so that you don't worry.
2863
2864 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2865 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2866 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2867 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2868 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2869 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2870 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2871 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002872
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002873 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2874 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2875 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2876 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2877 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2878 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2879 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2880 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2881
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002882 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002883 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002884 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2885 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002886 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002887 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2888 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2889 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2890 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2891 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002892 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2893 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2894 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2895 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2896 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2897 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002898
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002899 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2900 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2901 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2902 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2903 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2904 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2905 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2906 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002907 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002908 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002909 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2910 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2911 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002912
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002913 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2914 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2915 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2916 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2917 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2918 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2919 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2920 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2921 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2922 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2923 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2924 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002925
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002926 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002927 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2928 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2929 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2930 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2931 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2932 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2933 URIs start with a leading "/".
2934
2935 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2936 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2937 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2938 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2939
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002940 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002941 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2942
2943 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002944 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2945 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002946 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2947 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2948 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2949 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002950 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002951 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2952 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002953
2954 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2955 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2956 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2957 server will receive the request.
2958
2959 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2960 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2961 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2962 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2963 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002964 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2965 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2966 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002967
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002968 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2969 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2970 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2971 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2972 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002973
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002974 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002975 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2976 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2977 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2978
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002979 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2980 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2981 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2982
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002983 random
2984 random(<draws>)
2985 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002986 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2987 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2988 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2989 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002990 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2991 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2992 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2993 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2994 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2995 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2996 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2997 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2998 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2999 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3000 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3001 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3002 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3003 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3004 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3005 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3006 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3007 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3008 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3009 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003010
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003011 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003012 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003013 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3014 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3015 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3016 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3017 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3018 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003019 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003020 used instead.
3021
3022 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3023 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3024 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3025 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3026
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003027 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3028 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3029 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3030
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003031 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003032
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003033 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003034 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3035 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003036
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003037 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3038 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3039 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003040
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003041 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003042 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003043 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3044 NTLM relies on.
3045
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003046 Examples :
3047 balance roundrobin
3048 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003049 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003050 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3051 balance hdr(host)
3052 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003053
3054 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3055 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3056
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003057 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003058 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3059 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3060 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003061 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003062
3063 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3064 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3065 defaults to 16 kB.
3066
3067 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3068 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3069
3070 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3071 Round Robin.
3072
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003073 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003074 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3075 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3076 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3077
3078 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3079
3080 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003081 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003082 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3083 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3084 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003085
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003086 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003087
3088
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003089bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3090bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003091 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3093 no | yes | yes | no
3094 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003095 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3096 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3097 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3098 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003099 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003100 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3101 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3102 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3103 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3104 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3105 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
3106 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003107 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3108 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3109 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3110 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3111 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3112 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3113 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003114 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3115 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3116 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003117 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3118 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3119 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3120 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003121 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3122 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3123 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003124
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003125 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3126 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003127 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3128 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3129 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003130 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3131 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3132 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3133 the range.
3134
3135 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3136 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3137 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3138 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3139 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3140 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3141 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003142 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003143 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003144
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003145 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003146 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003147 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3148 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3149 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3150 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3151 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3152 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3153
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003154 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3155 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3156 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3157 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003158
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003159 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3160 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3161 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3162 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3163 in a frontend.
3164
3165 Example :
3166 listen http_proxy
3167 bind :80,:443
3168 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003169 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003170
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003171 listen http_https_proxy
3172 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003173 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003174
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003175 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3176 bind ipv6@:80
3177 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3178 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3179
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003180 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003181 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003182
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003183 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3184 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3185 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3186 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3187 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3188
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003189 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003190 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003191
3192
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003193bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003194 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3196 yes | yes | yes | yes
3197 Arguments :
3198 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3199 may be used to override a default value.
3200
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003201 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003202 option may be combined with other numbers.
3203
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003204 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003205 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3206 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3207 missing from all processes.
3208
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003209 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003210 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003211 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3212 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3213 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3214 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3215 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003216 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003217
3218 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3219 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3220 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3221 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3222 and 'even' instances.
3223
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003224 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3225 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3226 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3227 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003228
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003229 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3230 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3231
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003232 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3233 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3234 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3235
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003236 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3237 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3238
3239 Example :
3240 listen app_ip1
3241 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003242 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003243
3244 listen app_ip2
3245 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003246 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003247
3248 listen management
3249 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003250 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003251
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003252 listen management
3253 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3254 bind-process 1-4
3255
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003256 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003257
3258
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003259capture cookie <name> len <length>
3260 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3262 no | yes | yes | no
3263 Arguments :
3264 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3265 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3266 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3267 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003268 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003269
3270 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3271 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3272 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3273 right if it exceeds <length>.
3274
3275 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3276 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3277 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3278 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3279
3280 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3281 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3282 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3283
3284 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3285 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3286 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003287 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3288 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3289 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003290
3291 Example:
3292 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3293
3294 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003295 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003296
3297
3298capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003299 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3301 no | yes | yes | no
3302 Arguments :
3303 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003304 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003305 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3306 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3307 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3308
3309 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3310 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3311 it exceeds <length>.
3312
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003313 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003314 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3315 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003316 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3317 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3318 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3319 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003320 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003321 environments to find where the request came from.
3322
3323 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3324 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3325 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3326 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003327
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003328 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3329 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3330 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3331 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3332 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003333
3334 Example:
3335 capture request header Host len 15
3336 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003337 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003338
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003339 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003340 about logging.
3341
3342
3343capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003344 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3346 no | yes | yes | no
3347 Arguments :
3348 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003349 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003350 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3351 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3352 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3353
3354 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3355 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3356 it exceeds <length>.
3357
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003358 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003359 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3360 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3361 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003362 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3363 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3364 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3365 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003366
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003367 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3368 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3369 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3370 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3371 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003372
3373 Example:
3374 capture response header Content-length len 9
3375 capture response header Location len 15
3376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003377 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003378 about logging.
3379
3380
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003381compression algo <algorithm> ...
3382compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003383compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003384 Enable HTTP compression.
3385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3386 yes | yes | yes | yes
3387 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003388 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3389 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3390 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3391
3392 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003393 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3394 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3395 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003396
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003397 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003398 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003399
3400 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3401 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3402 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3403 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3404 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003405 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003406
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003407 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3408 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3409 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3410 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3411 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3412 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3413 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003414 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003415
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003416 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003417 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003418 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3419 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3420 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3421 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3422 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003423
3424 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3425 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3426 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3427 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3428 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003429 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3430 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3431 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3432 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3433 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003434 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3435 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003436
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003437 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003438 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3439 "Accept-Encoding" header
3440 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003441 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003442 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3443 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3444 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3445 "multipart"
3446 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3447 header
3448 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3449 and later
3450 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3451 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003452 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003453
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003454 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003455
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003456 Examples :
3457 compression algo gzip
3458 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003459
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003460
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003461cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003462 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3463 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003464 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003465 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3467 yes | no | yes | yes
3468 Arguments :
3469 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3470 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3471 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3472 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3473 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3474 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003475 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003476 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3477 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3478
3479 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3480 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3481 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3482 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3483 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3484 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003485 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3486 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003487 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003488 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3489 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003490
3491 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003492 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003493
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003494 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003495 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003496 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003497 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003498 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3499 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3500 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3501 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3502 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3503 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3504 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003505
3506 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3507 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3508 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3509 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3510 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3511 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3512 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3513 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3514 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003515 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003516 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3517 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3518 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003519
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003520 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3521 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3522 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003523 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3524 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3525 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3526 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003527 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3528 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3529 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003530
3531 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3532 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3533 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3534 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3535 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3536 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3537 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3538 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3539 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3540
3541 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3542 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3543 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3544 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3545 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3546 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3547 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3548 persistence cookie in the cache.
3549 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3550
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003551 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3552 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3553 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3554 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3555 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003556 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003557 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3558 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3559 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3560 they logout.
3561
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003562 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3563 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3564 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3565 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3566
3567 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3568 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3569 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3570 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3571 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3572 this attribute.
3573
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003574 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003575 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003576 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3577 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3578 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3579 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3580 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3581 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003582
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003583 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3584 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3585 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3586 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3587 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3588 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3589 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3590 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003591 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003592 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3593 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3594 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3595 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3596 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3597 the site.
3598
3599 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3600 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3601 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3602 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3603 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3604 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3605 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3606 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3607 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3608 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3609 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3610 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3611 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003612 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003613 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3614 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3615
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003616 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3617 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3618 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3619 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3620 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3621 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3622
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003623 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3624 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3625 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3626 repeated.
3627
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003628 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3629 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3630 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3631 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003632
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003633 Examples :
3634 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3635 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3636 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003637 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003638
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003639 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003640
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003641
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003642declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3643 Declares a capture slot.
3644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3645 no | yes | yes | no
3646 Arguments:
3647 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3648
3649 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3650 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3651 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3652 for use in the response.
3653
3654 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003655 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003656 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3657
3658
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003659default-server [param*]
3660 Change default options for a server in a backend
3661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3662 yes | no | yes | yes
3663 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003664 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3665 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3666 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3667 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003668
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003669 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003670 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3671
3672 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003673
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003674
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003675default_backend <backend>
3676 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3678 yes | yes | yes | no
3679 Arguments :
3680 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3681
3682 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3683 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3684 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3685 will catch all undetermined requests.
3686
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003687 Example :
3688
3689 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3690 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3691 default_backend dynamic
3692
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003693 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003694
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003695
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003696description <string>
3697 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3699 no | yes | yes | yes
3700 Arguments : string
3701
3702 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3703 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3704 it describes.
3705 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3706
3707
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003708disabled
3709 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3711 yes | yes | yes | yes
3712 Arguments : none
3713
3714 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3715 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3716 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3717 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3718 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3719 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3720 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3721
3722 See also : "enabled"
3723
3724
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003725dispatch <address>:<port>
3726 Set a default server address
3727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3728 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003729 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003730
3731 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3732 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3733 during start-up.
3734
3735 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3736 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3737 possible with normal servers.
3738
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003739 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003740 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3741 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3742 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3743 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3744
3745 See also : "server"
3746
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003747
3748dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3749 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3751 yes | no | yes | yes
3752 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3753
3754 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003755 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003756 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3757 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003758 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003759 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003760
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003761enabled
3762 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3764 yes | yes | yes | yes
3765 Arguments : none
3766
3767 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3768 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3769
3770 See also : "disabled"
3771
3772
3773errorfile <code> <file>
3774 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3776 yes | yes | yes | yes
3777 Arguments :
3778 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003779 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3780 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003781
3782 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003783 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003784 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003785 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3786 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003787
3788 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3789 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3790 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3791
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003792 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3793
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003794 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3795 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3796 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3797 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3798
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003799 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3800 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003801 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003802 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3803 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3804 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3805
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003806 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3807 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3808 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003809 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003810 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3811
3812 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3813
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003814 Example :
3815 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003816 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003817 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3818 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3819
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003820
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003821errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3822 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3823 section.
3824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3825 yes | yes | yes | yes
3826 Arguments :
3827 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3828
3829 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
3830 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 403,
3831 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3832
3833 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3834 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3835 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3836 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3837 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3838 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3839 hand using "errorfile" directives.
3840
3841 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" , "errorloc303" and section
3842 3.8 about http-errors.
3843
3844 Example :
3845 errorfiles generic
3846 errorfiles site-1 403 404
3847
3848
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003849errorloc <code> <url>
3850errorloc302 <code> <url>
3851 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3853 yes | yes | yes | yes
3854 Arguments :
3855 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003856 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3857 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003858
3859 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3860 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3861 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3862 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003863 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003864
3865 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3866 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3867 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3868
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003869 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3870
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003871 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3872 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3873 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3874 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003875 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003876 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3877 request.
3878
3879 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3880
3881
3882errorloc303 <code> <url>
3883 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3885 yes | yes | yes | yes
3886 Arguments :
3887 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003888 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3889 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003890
3891 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3892 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3893 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3894 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003895 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003896
3897 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3898 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3899 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3900
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003901 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3902
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003903 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3904 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3905 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3906 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003907 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003908
3909 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3910
3911
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003912email-alert from <emailaddr>
3913 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003914 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003915 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3916 yes | yes | yes | yes
3917
3918 Arguments :
3919
3920 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3921
3922 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3923 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3924
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003925 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003926 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3927 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003928
3929
3930email-alert level <level>
3931 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3932 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3933 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3934 yes | yes | yes | yes
3935
3936 Arguments :
3937
3938 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3939 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3940 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3941
3942 By default level is alert
3943
3944 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3945 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3946 for the proxy.
3947
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003948 Alerts are sent when :
3949
3950 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3951 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3952 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3953 is notice or lower
3954 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3955 and a health check status update occurs
3956
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003957 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3958 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003959 section 3.6 about mailers.
3960
3961
3962email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3963 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3964 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3965 yes | yes | yes | yes
3966
3967 Arguments :
3968
3969 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3970
3971 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3972 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3973
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003974 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3975 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003976
3977
3978email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3979 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3980 mailers.
3981 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3982 yes | yes | yes | yes
3983
3984 Arguments :
3985
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003986 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003987
3988 By default the systems hostname is used.
3989
3990 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3991 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3992 for the proxy.
3993
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003994 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3995 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003996
3997
3998email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003999 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004000 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4001 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4002 yes | yes | yes | yes
4003
4004 Arguments :
4005
4006 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4007
4008 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4009 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4010
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004011 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004012 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4013
4014
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004015force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4016 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4017 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004018 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004019
4020 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4021 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4022 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4023 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4024 marked down for maintenance operations.
4025
4026 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4027 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4028 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4029 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4030 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4031 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4032 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4033 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4034 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4035
4036 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4037 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4038 is used.
4039
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004040 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004041 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004042
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004043
4044filter <name> [param*]
4045 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4047 no | yes | yes | yes
4048 Arguments :
4049 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4050 referenced in section 9.
4051
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004052 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004053 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004054 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4055 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004056
4057 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4058 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4059
4060 Example:
4061 listen
4062 bind *:80
4063
4064 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4065 filter compression
4066 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4067
4068 compression algo gzip
4069 compression offload
4070
4071 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4072
4073 See also : section 9.
4074
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004075
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004076fullconn <conns>
4077 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4079 yes | no | yes | yes
4080 Arguments :
4081 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4082 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4083
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004084 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004085 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004086 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004087 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4088 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4089 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4090 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4091 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004092 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004093
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004094 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4095 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004096 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4097 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4098 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004099
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004100 Example :
4101 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4102 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4103 # connections.
4104 backend dynamic
4105 fullconn 10000
4106 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4107 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4108
4109 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4110
4111
4112grace <time>
4113 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004115 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004116 Arguments :
4117 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4118 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4119 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4120
4121 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4122 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004123 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004124 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4125
4126 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4127 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4128 simplify it.
4129
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004130
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004131hash-balance-factor <factor>
4132 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4134 yes | no | no | yes
4135 Arguments :
4136 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4137 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004138 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004139
4140 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4141 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4142 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4143 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4144 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4145 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4146 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4147
4148 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4149 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4150 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4151 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4152 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4153
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004154 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4155 consistent hashing mechanism.
4156
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004157 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4158
4159
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004160hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004161 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4163 yes | no | yes | yes
4164 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004165 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4166 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004167
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004168 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4169 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4170 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4171 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4172 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4173 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4174 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4175 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4176 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4177 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004178
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004179 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4180 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4181 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4182 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4183 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4184 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4185 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4186 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4187 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4188 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4189 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4190 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4191 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004192 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4193 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004194
4195 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4196
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004197 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004198 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4199 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4200 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004201 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4202 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4203 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004204
4205 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4206 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004207 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4208 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4209 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4210 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4211
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004212 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4213 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4214 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4215 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4216 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4217 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4218 parameter.
4219
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004220 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4221 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4222 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4223 used on strings.
4224
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004225 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4226
4227 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4228 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4229 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4230 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4231 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4232 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4233 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4234 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4235 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4236 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4237 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4238 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004239
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004240 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4241 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4242 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004243
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004244 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004245
4246
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004247http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4248 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4249 ones).
4250
4251 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4252 no | yes | yes | yes
4253
4254 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4255 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4256 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4257 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4258 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4259 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4260
4261 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4262 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4263 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4264
4265 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4266 below.
4267
4268 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4269 instance.
4270
4271 Example:
4272 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4273 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4274 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4275
4276http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4277
4278 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4279 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4280 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4281 example, or to pass some internal information.
4282 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4283 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4284 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4285
4286http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4287
4288 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4289 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4290
4291http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4292
4293 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4294
4295http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4296 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4297
4298 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4299
4300 Example:
4301 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4302
4303 # applied to:
4304 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4305
4306 # outputs:
4307 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4308
4309 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4310
4311http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4312 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4313
4314 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4315
4316 Example:
4317 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4318
4319 # applied to:
4320 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4321
4322 # outputs:
4323 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4324
4325http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4326
4327 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4328 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4329 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4330
4331http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4332 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4333
4334 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4335 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4336 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4337 fallback.
4338
4339 Example:
4340 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4341 http-response set-status 431
4342 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4343 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4344
4345http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4346
4347 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4348 inline.
4349
4350 Arguments:
4351 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4352 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4353 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4354 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4355 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4356 (request and response)
4357 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4358 processing
4359 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4360 processing
4361 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4362 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4363 and '_'.
4364
4365 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4366 followed by some converters.
4367
4368 Example:
4369 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4370
4371http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4372
4373 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4374 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4375 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4376 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4377 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004378 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004379 processing.
4380
4381 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4382 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4383 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
4384 rules evaluation.
4385
4386http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4387
4388 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4389 details about <var-name>.
4390
4391 Example:
4392 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4393
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004394
4395http-check comment <string>
4396 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
4397 it fails.
4398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4399 yes | no | yes | yes
4400
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004401 Arguments :
4402 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
4403 rule fails.
4404
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004405 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
4406 user-friendly error reporting.
4407
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004408 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check conncet", "http-check send" and
4409 "http-check expect".
4410
4411
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004412http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
4413 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004414 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004415 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
4416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4417 yes | no | yes | yes
4418
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004419 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004420 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4421
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004422 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
4423 checks. The server options are used only if not redifined.
4424
4425 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
4426 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
4427 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
4428 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
4429
4430 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
4431
4432 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
4433
4434 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
4435
4436 ssl opens a ciphered connection
4437
4438 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
4439
4440 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
4441 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
4442 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
4443 is used.
4444
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004445 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
4446 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
4447 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
4448 haproxy -vv.
4449
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004450 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
4451
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004452 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
4453 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
4454 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
4455 different ports or with different servers.
4456
4457 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
4458 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
4459 the port with a "http-check connect".
4460
4461 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
4462 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
4463 do.
4464
4465 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
4466 unset-var or comment rules.
4467
4468 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004469 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
4470 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
4471 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
4472 option httpchk
4473
4474 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004475 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004476 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004477 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004478 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004479 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004480
4481 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
4482
4483 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004484
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004485
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004486http-check disable-on-404
4487 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004489 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004490 Arguments : none
4491
4492 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4493 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4494 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4495 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4496 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4497 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4498 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4499 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004500 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4501 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4502 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4503
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004504 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004505
4506
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004507http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004508 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
4509 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
4510 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004511 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004513 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004514
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004515 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004516 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4517
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004518 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
4519 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
4520 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
4521 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
4522 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
4523 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
4524 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
4525 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
4526 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
4527 result is always conclusive.
4528
4529 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4530 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
4531 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
4532 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported and may be used to set,
4533 respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7OK, HCHK_STATUS_L7OKCD,
4534 HCHK_STATUS_L6OK or HCHK_STATUS_L4OK success status.
4535 By default "L7OK" is used.
4536
4537 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4538 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
4539 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported and
4540 may be used to set, respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7RSP,
4541 HCHK_STATUS_L7STS, HCHK_STATUS_L6RSP or HCHK_STATUS_L4CON
4542 error status. By default "L7RSP" is used.
4543
4544 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4545 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
4546 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported and may
4547 be used to set, respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7TOUT,
4548 HCHK_STATUS_L6TOUT or HCHK_STATUS_L4TOUT timeout status.
4549 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
4550
4551 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4552 informational message reported in logs if the expect
4553 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
4554 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
4555
4556 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4557 informational message reported in logs if an error
4558 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
4559 log-format string.
4560
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004561 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4562 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004563 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004564 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4565 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4566 details on the supported keywords.
4567
4568 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4569 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4570 with the usual backslash ('\').
4571
4572 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4573 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4574 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4575 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4576 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4577
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004578 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
4579 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
4580 codes. A health check response will be considered as
4581 valid if the response's status code matches any status
4582 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
4583 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4584 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004585
4586 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004587 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004588 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4589 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4590 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4591 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4592
4593 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004594 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004595 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4596 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4597 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4598 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4599 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004600 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004601 trace).
4602
4603 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004604 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004605 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4606 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4607 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4608 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4609 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004610 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004611
4612 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4613 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4614 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4615 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4616 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4617 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4618 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4619 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4620
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004621 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
4622 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
4623 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
4624 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
4625 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004626
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004627 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4628 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4629
4630 Examples :
4631 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004632 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004633
4634 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004635 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004636
4637 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004638 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004639
4640 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004641 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004642
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004643 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004644 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004645
4646
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02004647http-check send [meth <method>] [uri <uri>] [ver <version>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004648 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [body <string>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004649 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
4650 health checks.
4651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4652 yes | no | yes | yes
4653 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004654 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4655
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004656 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
4657 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
4658 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
4659 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
4660 to invent non-standard ones.
4661
4662 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests.
4663 it defaults to " / " which is accessible by default on almost
4664 any server, but may be changed to any other URI. Query
4665 strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004666
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02004667 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004668 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
4669 1.0, so turningit to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
4670 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
4671 to add it.
4672
4673 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4674 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
4675 to the log-format rules.
4676
4677 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
4678 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
4679 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004680
4681 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
4682 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
4683 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02004684 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
4685 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
4686 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
4687 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004688 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
4689 "http-check expect" direcive is defined independently of this directive, just
4690 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
4691
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004692 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4693 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02004694 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
4695 so, it will be ignored.
4696
4697 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
4698 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
4699 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
4700 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
4701 configured request authority.
4702
4703 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
4704 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004705
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004706 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004707
4708
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004709http-check send-state
4710 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4712 yes | no | yes | yes
4713 Arguments : none
4714
4715 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4716 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4717 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4718 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4719 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4720
4721 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4722 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4723 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4724 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4725 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004726 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4727 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4728 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4729
4730 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4731 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4732 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4733
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004734 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4735 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4736 checked in multiple backends.
4737
4738 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4739 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4740
4741 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4742 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4743 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4744 one fails.
4745
4746 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4747 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4748 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4749
4750 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4751 server's queue.
4752
4753 Example of a header received by the application server :
4754 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4755 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4756
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004757 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
4758 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004759
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004760
4761http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004762 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004763 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4764 yes | no | yes | yes
4765
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004766 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004767 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4768 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
4769 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
4770 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
4771 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
4772 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4773 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
4774 and '-'.
4775
4776 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
4777
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004778 Examples :
4779 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004780
4781
4782http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004783 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004784 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4785 yes | no | yes | yes
4786
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004787 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004788 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4789 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
4790 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
4791 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
4792 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
4793 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4794 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
4795 and '-'.
4796
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004797 Examples :
4798 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004799
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004800
4801http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004802 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4803
4804 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4805 no | yes | yes | yes
4806
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004807 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4808 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4809 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4810 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4811 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004812
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004813 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4814 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004815
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004816 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004817
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004818 Example:
4819 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4820 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4821 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004822
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004823 http-request allow if nagios
4824 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4825 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4826 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004827
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004828 Example:
4829 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4830 acl add path /addacl
4831 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004832
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004833 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004834
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004835 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4836 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004837
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004838 Example:
4839 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4840 acl setmap path /setmap
4841 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004842
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004843 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004844
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004845 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4846 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004847
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004848 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4849 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004850
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004851http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004852
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004853 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4854 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4855 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4856 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4857 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4858 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4859 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4860 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004861
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004862http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004863
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004864 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4865 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4866 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4867 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4868 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4869 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4870 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4871 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004872
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004873http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004874
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004875 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4876 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004877
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004878
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004879http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004880
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004881 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4882 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4883 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4884 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4885 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004886
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004887 Example:
4888 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4889 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004890
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004891http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004892
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004893 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004894
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004895http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4896 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004897
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004898 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4899 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4900 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4901 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4902 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4903 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4904 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4905 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4906 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004907
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004908 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4909 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4910 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01004911 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
4912
4913 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
4914 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
4915 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
4916 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004917
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004918http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004919
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004920 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4921 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4922 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4923 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4924 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4925 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004926
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004927http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004928
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004929 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004930
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004931http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004932
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004933 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4934 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4935 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4936 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4937 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4938 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004939
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004940http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
4941 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004942
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004943 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4944 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4945 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004946 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
4947 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
4948 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
4949 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
4950 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004951 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004952
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004953http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4954 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4955 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4956 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4957
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004958http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4959
4960 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4961 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4962 pointed by <resolvers>.
4963 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4964 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4965 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4966 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4967 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4968 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4969 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4970 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4971 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4972 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4973 to 0.0.0.0.
4974
4975 Example:
4976 resolvers mydns
4977 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4978 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4979 timeout retry 1s
4980 hold valid 10s
4981 hold nx 3s
4982 hold other 3s
4983 hold obsolete 0s
4984 accepted_payload_size 8192
4985
4986 frontend fe
4987 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4988 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4989 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4990
4991 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4992 # which mean DNS resolution error
4993 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4994
4995 default_backend be
4996
4997 backend b_503
4998 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4999 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5000 # 503 error page to end users
5001
5002 backend be
5003 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5004 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5005 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5006 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5007 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5008
5009 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5010 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5011
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005012http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5013
5014 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5015 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5016 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5017 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005018 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5019 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005020
5021 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5022
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005023http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005024
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005025 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5026 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5027 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5028 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5029 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005030
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005031http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005032
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005033 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5034 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5035 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5036 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005037
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005038http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5039 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005040
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005041 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005042 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5043 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5044 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5045 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5046 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005047
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005048 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5049 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5050 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5051 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5052 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005053
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005054 Example:
5055 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5056
5057 # applied to:
5058 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5059
5060 # outputs:
5061 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5062
5063 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005064
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005065 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5066
5067 # applied to:
5068 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005069
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005070 # outputs:
5071 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005072
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005073http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5074 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5075
5076 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5077 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
5078 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
5079 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
5080
5081 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5082 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5083 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5084
5085 Example:
5086 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5087 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5088
5089 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5090 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5091
5092 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5093 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5094 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5095 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5096
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005097http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5098 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5099
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005100 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5101 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5102 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5103 against.
5104
5105 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5106 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5107 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005108
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005109 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5110 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5111 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5112 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5113 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5114 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5115 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5116 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5117 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005118 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5119 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005120
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005121 Example:
5122 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5123 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005124
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005125 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5126 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005127
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005128http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5129 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005130
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005131 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5132 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5133 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5134 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005135
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005136 Example:
5137 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005138
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005139 # applied to:
5140 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005141
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005142 # outputs:
5143 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005144
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005145http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5146 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5147 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005148 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005149 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5150
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005151 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005152 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5153 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5154 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5155 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005156 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005157 are followed to create the response :
5158
5159 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5160 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5161 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5162 ignored.
5163
5164 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5165 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
5166 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
5167 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5168 ignored.
5169
5170 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5171 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5172 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
5173 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
5174 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
5175
5176 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5177 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5178 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5179 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
5180 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
5181 if any, is ignored.
5182
5183 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5184 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5185 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5186 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5187 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5188 as a raw content.
5189
5190 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5191 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5192 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5193 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5194 considered as a raw string.
5195
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005196 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5197 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5198 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5199 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5200
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005201 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5202 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
5203 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
5204
5205 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5206
5207 Example:
5208 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5209 if { path /ping }
5210
5211 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
5212 if { path /favicon.ico }
5213
5214 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
5215 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
5216 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
5217
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005218http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5219http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005220
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005221 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5222 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5223 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005224
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005225http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5226 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005227
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005228 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5229 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5230 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5231 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005232
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005233http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005234
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005235 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5236 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5237 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5238 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5239 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005240
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005241 Arguments:
5242 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5243 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005244
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005245 Example:
5246 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5247 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005248
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005249 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5250 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005251
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005252http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005253
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005254 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5255 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5256 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005257
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005258 Arguments:
5259 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5260 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005261
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005262 Example:
5263 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5264 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005265
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005266 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5267 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5268 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005269
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005270http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005271
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005272 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5273 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5274 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5275 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5276 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005277
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005278 Example:
5279 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5280 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5281 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5282 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5283 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5284 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5285 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5286 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5287 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005288
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005289http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005290
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005291 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5292 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5293 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5294 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5295 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005296
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005297http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5298 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005299
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005300 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5301 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5302 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5303 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5304 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5305 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5306 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5307 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5308 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005309
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005310http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005311
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005312 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5313 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5314 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5315 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5316 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5317 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5318 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005319
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005320http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005321
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005322 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5323 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5324 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005325
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005326http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005327
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005328 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5329 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5330 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5331 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5332 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5333 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5334 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5335 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005336
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005337http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005338
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005339 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5340 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5341 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5342 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5343 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5344 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005345
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005346 Example :
5347 # prepend the host name before the path
5348 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005349
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005350http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005351
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005352 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5353 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5354 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5355 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5356 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005357
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005358http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005359
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005360 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5361 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5362 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5363 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5364 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5365 values have higher priority.
5366 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5367 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5368 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5369 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5370 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005371
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005372http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005373
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005374 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5375 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5376 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5377 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5378 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5379 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5380 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005381
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005382 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005383
5384 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005385 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5386 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005387
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005388http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5389 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5390 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5391 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005392 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5393 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005394
5395 Arguments :
5396 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5397 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005398
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005399 See also "option forwardfor".
5400
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005401 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005402 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5403 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5404
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005405 # After the masking this will track connections
5406 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5407 http-request track-sc0 src
5408
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005409 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5410 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5411
5412http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5413
5414 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5415 expression.
5416
5417 Arguments:
5418 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5419 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005420
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005421 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005422 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5423 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5424
5425 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5426 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5427 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5428
5429http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5430
5431 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5432 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5433 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5434 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5435 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5436 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5437 information from the request.
5438
5439 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5440
5441http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5442
5443 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5444 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5445 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5446 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5447 path and the query string.
5448 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5449
5450http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5451
5452 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5453 inline.
5454
5455 Arguments:
5456 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5457 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5458 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5459 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5460 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5461 (request and response)
5462 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5463 processing
5464 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5465 processing
5466 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5467 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5468 and '_'.
5469
5470 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5471 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005472
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005473 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005474 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005475
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005476http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5477 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005478
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005479 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5480 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5481 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5482 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5483 agent name must be used.
5484
5485 Arguments:
5486 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5487
5488 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5489 configuration.
5490
5491http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5492
5493 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5494 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5495 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5496 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5497 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5498 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5499 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5500 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5501 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5502 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5503 action.
5504 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5505 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5506 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5507 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5508 you fully understand how it works.
5509
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005510http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5511
5512 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5513 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5514 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5515 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5516 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005517 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005518 processing.
5519
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005520 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005521 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5522 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5523 rules evaluation.
5524
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005525http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5526 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005527
5528 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
5529 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
5530 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
5531 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
5532 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
5533 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
5534 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
5535 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
5536 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
5537 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
5538 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005539 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. A specific error
5540 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5541 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5542 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5543 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005544 See also the "silent-drop" action.
5545
5546http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5547http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5548http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5549
5550 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
5551 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
5552 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
5553 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
5554 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
5555 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5556 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
5557 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
5558 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5559 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
5560 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
5561 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
5562
5563 Arguments :
5564 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
5565 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
5566 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
5567 select which table entry to update the counters.
5568
5569 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
5570 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
5571 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
5572 that table until the session ends.
5573
5574 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
5575 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
5576 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
5577 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
5578 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
5579 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
5580 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
5581 useful information.
5582
5583 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
5584 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
5585 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
5586 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
5587 checks that make use of it.
5588
5589http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5590
5591 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005592
5593 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005594 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005595
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005596http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5597
5598 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5599 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5600 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5601 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5602 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5603 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5604
5605 Arguments :
5606 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5607
5608 Example:
5609 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5610
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005611http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005612
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005613 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5614 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5615 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005616
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005617
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005618http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005619 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5620
5621 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5622 no | yes | yes | yes
5623
5624 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5625 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5626 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5627 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5628 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5629 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5630
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005631 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5632 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005633
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005634 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005635
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005636 Example:
5637 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005638
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005639 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005640
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005641 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5642 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005643
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005644 Example:
5645 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005646
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005647 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005648
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005649 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5650 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005651
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005652 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5653 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005654
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005655http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005656
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005657 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5658 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5659 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5660 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5661 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5662 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5663 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5664 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005665
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005666http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005667
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005668 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5669 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5670 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5671 example, or to pass some internal information.
5672 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5673 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5674 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005675
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005676http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005677
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005678 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5679 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005680
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005681http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005682
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005683 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005684
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005685http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005686
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005687 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5688 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5689 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5690 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5691 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5692 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5693 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005694
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005695 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5696 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5697 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5698 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5699 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005700
5701 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5702 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5703 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5704 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005705
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005706http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005707
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005708 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5709 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5710 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5711 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5712 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5713 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005714
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005715http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005716
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005717 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005718
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005719http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005720
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005721 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5722 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5723 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5724 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5725 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5726 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005727
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005728http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5729 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005730
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005731 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005732 and emits an HTTP 502 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
5733 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005734 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
5735 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5736 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5737 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5738 followed by the section name.
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005739 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005740
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005741http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005742
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005743 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5744 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5745 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5746 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5747 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5748 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005749
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005750http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5751 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005752
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005753 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5754 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005755
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005756 Example:
5757 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005758
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005759 # applied to:
5760 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005761
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005762 # outputs:
5763 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005764
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005765 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005766
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005767http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5768 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005769
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01005770 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005771 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005772
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005773 Example:
5774 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005775
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005776 # applied to:
5777 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005778
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005779 # outputs:
5780 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005781
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005782http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5783 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5784 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005785 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005786 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5787
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005788 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005789 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5790 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5791 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5792 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005793 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005794 are followed to create the response :
5795
5796 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5797 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5798 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5799 ignored.
5800
5801 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5802 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
5803 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
5804 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5805 ignored.
5806
5807 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5808 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5809 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
5810 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
5811 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
5812
5813 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5814 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5815 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5816 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
5817 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
5818 if any, is ignored.
5819
5820 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5821 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5822 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5823 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5824 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5825 as a raw content.
5826
5827 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5828 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5829 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5830 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5831 considered as a raw string.
5832
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005833 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5834 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5835 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5836 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5837
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005838 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5839 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
5840 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
5841
5842 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
5843
5844 Example:
5845 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5846 if { status eq 404 }
5847
5848 http-response return content-type text/plain \
5849 string "This is the end !" \
5850 if { status eq 500 }
5851
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005852http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5853http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005854
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005855 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5856 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5857 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005858
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005859http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5860 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005861
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005862 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5863 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5864 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5865 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005866
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005867http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005868
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005869 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5870 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5871 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5872 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5873 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005874
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005875 Arguments:
5876 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005877
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005878 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5879 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005880
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005881http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005882
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005883 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5884 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5885 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005886
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005887http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5888
5889 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5890 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5891 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5892 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5893 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5894
5895http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5896
5897 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5898 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5899 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5900 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5901 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5902 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5903 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5904 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5905 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5906
5907http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5908
5909 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5910 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5911 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5912 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5913 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5914 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5915 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5916
5917http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5918
5919 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5920 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5921 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5922 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5923 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5924 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5925 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5926 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5927
5928http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5929 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5930
5931 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5932 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5933 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5934 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005935
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005936 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005937 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5938 http-response set-status 431
5939 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5940 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005941
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005942http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005943
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005944 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5945 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5946 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5947 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5948 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5949 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5950 based on some information from the request.
5951
5952 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5953
5954http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5955
5956 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5957 inline.
5958
5959 Arguments:
5960 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5961 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5962 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5963 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5964 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5965 (request and response)
5966 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5967 processing
5968 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5969 processing
5970 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5971 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5972 and '_'.
5973
5974 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5975 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005976
5977 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005978 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005979
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005980http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005981
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005982 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5983 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5984 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5985 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5986 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5987 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5988 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5989 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5990 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5991 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5992 action.
5993 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5994 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5995 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5996 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5997 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005998
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005999http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6000
6001 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6002 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6003 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6004 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6005 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006006 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006007 processing.
6008
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006009 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006010 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6011 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
6012 rules evaluation.
6013
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006014http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6015http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6016http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006017
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006018 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6019 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6020 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6021 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6022 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6023 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6024
6025http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6026
6027 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6028 about <var-name>.
6029
6030 Example:
6031 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6032
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006033
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006034http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6035 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6036
6037 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6038 yes | no | yes | yes
6039
6040 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006041 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6042 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6043 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006044
6045 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6046
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006047 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6048 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6049 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6050 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6051 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6052 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6053 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6054 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6055 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6056 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006057
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006058 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6059 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6060 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6061 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6062 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6063 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6064 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
6065 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006066
6067 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6068 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6069 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6070 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6071 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6072 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6073 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6074 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006075 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006076 downsides of rare connection failures.
6077
6078 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6079 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6080 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6081 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6082 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6083 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006084 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006085 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6086 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6087 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6088 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6089 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6090
6091 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006092 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6093 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6094 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006095
6096 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006097 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006098
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006099 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6100 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006101
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006102 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006103
6104 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6105 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6106 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6107
6108 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6109
6110
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006111http-send-name-header [<header>]
6112 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006113 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6114 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006115 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006116 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6117
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006118 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6119 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6120 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6121 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6122 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6123 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6124 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6125 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6126 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6127 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6128 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6129 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6130 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6131 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6132 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6133 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006134
6135 See also : "server"
6136
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006137id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006138 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6140 no | yes | yes | yes
6141 Arguments : none
6142
6143 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6144 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6145 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006146
6147
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006148ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6149 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6150 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006151 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006152
6153 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6154 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6155 and running).
6156
6157 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6158 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6159 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006160 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006161 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6162
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006163 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6164 "unless" condition is met.
6165
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006166 Example:
6167 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6168 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6169 ignore-persist if url_static
6170
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006171 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6172
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006173load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6174 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6175 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6176 yes | no | yes | yes
6177
6178 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6179 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6180 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006181 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006182 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6183 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
6184 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
6185 over the stats socket and redirect output.
6186
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006187 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006188 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02006189 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006190
6191 Arguments:
6192 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
6193 named "server-state-file".
6194
6195 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
6196 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
6197 name is used as a file name.
6198
6199 none don't load any stat for this backend
6200
6201 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006202 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
6203 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
6204 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006205 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006206 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006207
6208 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
6209 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
6210
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006211 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006212
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006213 global
6214 stats socket /tmp/socket
6215 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006216
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006217 defaults
6218 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006219
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006220 backend bk
6221 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6222 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006223
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006224
6225 Then one can run :
6226
6227 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
6228
6229 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6230
6231 1
6232 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6233 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6234 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6235
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006236 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006237
6238 global
6239 stats socket /tmp/socket
6240 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6241
6242 defaults
6243 load-server-state-from-file local
6244
6245 backend bk
6246 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6247 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6248
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006249
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006250 Then one can run :
6251
6252 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6253
6254 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6255
6256 1
6257 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6258 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6259 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6260
6261 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6262 "show servers state"
6263
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006264
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006265log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006266log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6267 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006268no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006269 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6271 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006272
6273 Prefix :
6274 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6275 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6276 prefix does not allow arguments.
6277
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006278 Arguments :
6279 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6280 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6281 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6282 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6283 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6284 parameter.
6285
6286 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6287 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6288
6289 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6290 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6291 standard syslog port).
6292
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006293 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6294 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6295 standard syslog port).
6296
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006297 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6298 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6299 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006300 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006301
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006302 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6303 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6304 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6305 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6306 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6307 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6308 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6309 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6310 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6311 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6312 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6313 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6314 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6315 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6316 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6317 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006318 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6319 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006320
6321 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6322 and "fd@2", see above.
6323
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006324 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6325 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6326 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6327 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6328 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6329 having the logs instantly available.
6330
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006331 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6332 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006333
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006334 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6335 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6336 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6337 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6338 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6339 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6340 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6341 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6342 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6343 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006344 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006345
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006346 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6347 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6348 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6349 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6350 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6351
6352 <sample_size>
6353 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6354 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6355 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6356 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6357 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6358
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006359 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6360 one of the following :
6361
6362 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6363 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6364
6365 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6366 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6367
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006368 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6369 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6370 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6371 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6372 systemd logger consumes.
6373
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006374 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6375 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6376 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6377 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6378
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006379 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6380
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006381 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6382 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6383 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6384
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006385 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6386 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6387 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6388 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006389
6390 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6391 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6392 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006393 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6394 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6395 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6396 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6397 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006398
6399 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6400
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006401 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6402 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6403 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006404
6405 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6406 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6407 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6408 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6409
6410 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6411 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006412
6413 Example :
6414 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006415 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6416 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6417 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006418 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6419 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006420 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006421
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006422
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006423log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006424 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6425 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6426 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006427
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006428 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6429 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6430 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6431 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6432 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006433
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006434 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6435 "option httplog" directives.
6436
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006437log-format-sd <string>
6438 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6439 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6440 yes | yes | yes | no
6441
6442 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6443 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6444 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6445 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6446 which covers the log format string in depth.
6447
6448 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6449 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6450
6451 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6452 log format to "rfc5424".
6453
6454 Example :
6455 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6456
6457
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006458log-tag <string>
6459 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6460 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6461 yes | yes | yes | yes
6462
6463 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6464 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6465 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6466 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6467 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6468 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6469 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6470 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6471 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006472
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006473max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6474 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6475 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6476 yes | no | yes | yes
6477
6478 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6479 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6480 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6481 servers.
6482
6483 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6484 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6485 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6486 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6487 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006488 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006489 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6490 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6491 picking a different server.
6492
6493 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6494 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6495 even if they have to be queued.
6496
6497 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6498 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6499
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006500max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6501 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
6502 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
6503 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006504
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006505maxconn <conns>
6506 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
6507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6508 yes | yes | yes | no
6509 Arguments :
6510 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
6511 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
6512 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
6513 closes.
6514
6515 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
6516 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
6517 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
6518 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01006519 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
6520 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
6521 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
6522 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006523
6524 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
6525 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
6526 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
6527
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01006528 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
6529 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02006530
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006531 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
6532
6533
6534mode { tcp|http|health }
6535 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
6536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6537 yes | yes | yes | yes
6538 Arguments :
6539 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
6540 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
6541 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
6542 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
6543
6544 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
6545 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
6546 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
6547 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
6548 brings HAProxy most of its value.
6549
6550 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006551 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
6552 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
6553 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
6554 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
6555 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
6556 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
6557 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006558
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006559 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
6560 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
6561 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006562
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006563 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006564 defaults http_instances
6565 mode http
6566
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006567 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006568
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006569
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006570monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006571 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6573 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006574 Arguments :
6575 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
6576 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006577 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006578 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
6579 backend and its backup.
6580
6581 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
6582 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
6583 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
6584 servers in a list of backends.
6585
6586 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
6587 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
6588 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
6589 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
6590 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
6591 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
6592 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006593 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
6594 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006595
6596 Example:
6597 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006598 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006599 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
6600 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
6601 monitor-uri /site_alive
6602 monitor fail if site_dead
6603
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006604 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006605
6606
6607monitor-net <source>
6608 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
6609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6610 yes | yes | yes | no
6611 Arguments :
6612 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
6613 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
6614 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
6615 followed by a mask.
6616
6617 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
6618 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006619 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006620 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
6621
6622 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
6623 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
6624 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
6625 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006626 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
6627 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
6628 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006629
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006630 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
6631 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
6632 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
6633 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
6634 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
6635 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006636
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01006637 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
6638 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006639
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006640 Example :
6641 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
6642 frontend www
6643 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
6644
6645 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
6646
6647
6648monitor-uri <uri>
6649 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
6650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6651 yes | yes | yes | no
6652 Arguments :
6653 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
6654 health status instead of forwarding the request.
6655
6656 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
6657 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
6658 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
6659 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
6660 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
6661 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
6662 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
6663 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
6664
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01006665 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006666 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
6667 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
6668 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
6669 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
6670 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
6671 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006672
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01006673 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
6674 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
6675 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
6676 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
6677
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006678 Example :
6679 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
6680 frontend www
6681 mode http
6682 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
6683
6684 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
6685
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006686
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006687option abortonclose
6688no option abortonclose
6689 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
6690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6691 yes | no | yes | yes
6692 Arguments : none
6693
6694 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6695 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6696 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6697 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006698 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006699 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6700 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6701 encountered while delivering the response.
6702
6703 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6704 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6705 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6706 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6707 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6708 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006709 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006710 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006711 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006712 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6713 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6714 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6715
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006716 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6717 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006718 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6719 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6720 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6721 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6722 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6723 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006724 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006725
6726 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6727 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6728
6729 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6730
6731
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006732option accept-invalid-http-request
6733no option accept-invalid-http-request
6734 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6736 yes | yes | yes | no
6737 Arguments : none
6738
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006739 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006740 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006741 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006742 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6743 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6744 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6745 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6746 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006747 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6748 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6749 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6750 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006751 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006752 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006753 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6754 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6755 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006756
6757 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6758 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6759 been confirmed.
6760
6761 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6762 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006763 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6764 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006765 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6766
6767 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6768 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6769
6770 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6771 stats socket.
6772
6773
6774option accept-invalid-http-response
6775no option accept-invalid-http-response
6776 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6778 yes | no | yes | yes
6779 Arguments : none
6780
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006781 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006782 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006783 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006784 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6785 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6786 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6787 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6788 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006789 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6790 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6791 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006792
6793 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6794 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6795 been confirmed.
6796
6797 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6798 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6799 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6800 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6801
6802 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6803 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6804
6805 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6806 stats socket.
6807
6808
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006809option allbackups
6810no option allbackups
6811 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6813 yes | no | yes | yes
6814 Arguments : none
6815
6816 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6817 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6818 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6819 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6820 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6821 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6822 order between the backup servers anymore.
6823
6824 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6825 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6826
6827 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6828 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6829
6830
6831option checkcache
6832no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006833 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6835 yes | no | yes | yes
6836 Arguments : none
6837
6838 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6839 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006840 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006841 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6842 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006843 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006844
6845 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006846 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006847 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006848 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6849 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006850 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006851 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006852 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6853 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006854 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006855 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6856 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006857 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006858 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6859 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6860 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6861 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6862 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6863 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6864 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6865 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6866 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6867
6868 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006869 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
6870 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
6871 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
6872 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006873
6874 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6875 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006876 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006877 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006878
6879 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6880 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6881
6882
6883option clitcpka
6884no option clitcpka
6885 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6887 yes | yes | yes | no
6888 Arguments : none
6889
6890 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6891 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006892 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006893 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6894
6895 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6896 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6897 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6898 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6899
6900 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6901 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6902 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6903 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6904 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6905
6906 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6907
6908 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6909 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6910 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6911
6912 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6913 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6914
6915 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6916
6917
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006918option contstats
6919 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6921 yes | yes | yes | no
6922 Arguments : none
6923
6924 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6925 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6926 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6927 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006928 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6929 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6930 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6931 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6932 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006933
6934
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006935option dontlog-normal
6936no option dontlog-normal
6937 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6939 yes | yes | yes | no
6940 Arguments : none
6941
6942 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6943 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6944 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6945 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6946 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6947 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6948 logged.
6949
6950 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6951 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6952 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6953
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006954 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006955 logging.
6956
6957
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006958option dontlognull
6959no option dontlognull
6960 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6962 yes | yes | yes | no
6963 Arguments : none
6964
6965 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6966 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6967 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6968 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6969 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6970 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006971 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6972 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6973 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006974
6975 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006976 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006977 would not be logged.
6978
6979 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6980 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6981
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006982 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6983 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006984
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006985
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006986option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006987 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6989 yes | yes | yes | yes
6990 Arguments :
6991 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6992 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006993 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006994 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006995
6996 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6997 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6998 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6999 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7000 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7001 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7002 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007003 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7004 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7005 possible that the client has already brought one.
7006
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007007 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007008 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007009 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007010 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007011 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007012 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007013
7014 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7015 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7016 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7017 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7018 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7019 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7020 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7021
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007022 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7023 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7024 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7025 are under the control of the end-user.
7026
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007027 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007028 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7029 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007030 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7031 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7032 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007033
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007034 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007035 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7036 frontend www
7037 mode http
7038 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7039
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007040 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7041 backend www
7042 mode http
7043 option forwardfor header X-Client
7044
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007045 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007046 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007047
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007048
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007049option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7050no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7051 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7053 yes | yes | yes | no
7054 Arguments : none
7055
7056 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7057 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7058 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7059 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7060 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7061 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7062 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7063
7064 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7065 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7066 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7067 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7068 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7069 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7070 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7071 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7072 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7073 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7074
7075 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7076
7077 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7078 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7079
7080 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7081 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7082
7083
7084option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7085no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7086 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7088 yes | no | yes | yes
7089 Arguments : none
7090
7091 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7092 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7093 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7094 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7095 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7096 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7097 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7098
7099 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7100 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7101 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7102 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7103 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7104 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7105 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7106 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7107 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7108 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7109
7110 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7111
7112 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7113 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7114
7115 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7116 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7117
7118
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007119option http-buffer-request
7120no option http-buffer-request
7121 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7123 yes | yes | yes | yes
7124 Arguments : none
7125
7126 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7127 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7128 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7129 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7130 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7131 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007132 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7133 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7134 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7135 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007136
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007137 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007138
7139
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007140option http-ignore-probes
7141no option http-ignore-probes
7142 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7144 yes | yes | yes | no
7145 Arguments : none
7146
7147 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7148 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7149 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7150 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7151 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7152 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7153 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7154 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7155 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007156 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7157 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007158 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7159
7160 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7161 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7162 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7163 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7164 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7165 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7166 are often the only way to detect them.
7167
7168 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7169 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7170
7171 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7172
7173
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007174option http-keep-alive
7175no option http-keep-alive
7176 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7178 yes | yes | yes | yes
7179 Arguments : none
7180
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007181 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7182 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007183 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7184 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007185 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7186 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7187 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007188
7189 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7190 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007191 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7192 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7193 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7194 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7195 situations where this option may be useful :
7196
7197 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007198 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007199
7200 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7201 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7202
7203 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
7204 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
7205 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
7206 request.
7207
7208 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
7209 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007210 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
7211 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
7212 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007213
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007214 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7215 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7216 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7217 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
7218 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7219 not set.
7220
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007221 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7222 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
7223 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007224
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007225 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007226 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01007227 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007228
7229
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007230option http-no-delay
7231no option http-no-delay
7232 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7234 yes | yes | yes | yes
7235 Arguments : none
7236
7237 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7238 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7239 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7240 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7241 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7242 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7243 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7244 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7245 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7246 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7247 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7248 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7249 affected.
7250
7251 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7252 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7253 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7254 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7255 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7256 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7257 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7258 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7259 latency environments.
7260
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007261 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7262
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007263
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007264option http-pretend-keepalive
7265no option http-pretend-keepalive
7266 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007268 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007269 Arguments : none
7270
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007271 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007272 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7273 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7274 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7275 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7276 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7277 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7278 consider the response complete.
7279
7280 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7281 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7282 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7283 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007284 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007285 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7286
7287 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7288 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7289 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7290 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7291 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7292 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7293 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7294
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007295 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7296 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7297 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7298 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7299 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7300 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007301
7302 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7303 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7304
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007305 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007306 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007307
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007308
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007309option http-server-close
7310no option http-server-close
7311 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7313 yes | yes | yes | yes
7314 Arguments : none
7315
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007316 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7317 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7318 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7319 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007320 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7321 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7322 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7323 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7324 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7325 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7326 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7327 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7328 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7329 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7330 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007331
7332 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7333 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7334 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7335 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007336 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7337 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007338
7339 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7340 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007341 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7342 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7343 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007344
7345 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7346 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7347
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007348 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7349 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007350
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007351option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007352no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007353 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7355 yes | yes | yes | no
7356 Arguments : none
7357
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007358 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007359 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7360 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7361 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7362 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7363 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7364 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7365
7366 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7367 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007368 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7369 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7370 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007371
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007372 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7373 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7374 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7375 front of an existing proxy.
7376
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007377 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7378
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007379 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007380
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007381option httpchk
7382option httpchk <uri>
7383option httpchk <method> <uri>
7384option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007385 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7387 yes | no | yes | yes
7388 Arguments :
7389 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7390 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7391 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7392 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7393 ones.
7394
7395 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7396 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7397 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7398
7399 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7400 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7401 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007402 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007403
7404 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7405 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7406 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7407 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7408 the lack of any response.
7409
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007410 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
7411 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
7412 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
7413 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
7414
7415 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
7416 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
7417 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007418
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007419 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
7420 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007421 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
7422 internally relies on an HTX mutliplexer. Thus, it means the request
7423 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007424
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007425 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
7426 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
7427 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
7428 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
7429
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007430 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007431 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7432 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7433 backend https_relay
7434 mode tcp
7435 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
7436 http-check send hdr Host www
7437 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007438
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007439 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7440 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7441 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007442
7443
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007444option httpclose
7445no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007446 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7448 yes | yes | yes | yes
7449 Arguments : none
7450
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007451 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7452 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7453 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7454 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007455 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007456
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007457 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7458 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007459 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007460 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7461 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007462
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007463 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7464 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7465 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007466
7467 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7468 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007469 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
7470 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7471 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007472
7473 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7474 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7475
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007476 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007477
7478
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007479option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007480 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007482 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007483 Arguments :
7484 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
7485 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
7486 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007487 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007488 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007489
7490 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7491 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7492 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
7493 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
7494 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
7495 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
7496 ports.
7497
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01007498 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
7499 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007500
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007501 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7502
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007503 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007504
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007505
7506option http_proxy
7507no option http_proxy
7508 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
7509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7510 yes | yes | yes | yes
7511 Arguments : none
7512
7513 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
7514 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
7515 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
7516 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
7517 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
7518
7519 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
7520 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007521 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
7522 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007523
7524 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7525 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7526
7527 Example :
7528 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
7529 backend direct_forward
7530 option httpclose
7531 option http_proxy
7532
7533 See also : "option httpclose"
7534
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007535
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007536option independent-streams
7537no option independent-streams
7538 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7540 yes | yes | yes | yes
7541 Arguments : none
7542
7543 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
7544 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
7545 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
7546 receive data or not.
7547
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007548 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007549 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
7550 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
7551 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
7552 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
7553 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
7554 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
7555 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
7556 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
7557 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
7558 socket buffers.
7559
7560 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
7561 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
7562 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
7563 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
7564 slow lines, so use it with caution.
7565
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007566 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007567
7568
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02007569option ldap-check
7570 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
7571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7572 yes | no | yes | yes
7573 Arguments : none
7574
7575 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
7576 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
7577 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
7578 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
7579
7580 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
7581 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
7582
7583 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
7584 configure it.
7585
7586 Example :
7587 option ldap-check
7588
7589 See also : "option httpchk"
7590
7591
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007592option external-check
7593 Use external processes for server health checks
7594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7595 yes | no | yes | yes
7596
7597 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
7598 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
7599 command".
7600
7601 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
7602
7603 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
7604
7605
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007606option log-health-checks
7607no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007608 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7610 yes | no | yes | yes
7611 Arguments : none
7612
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007613 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
7614 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
7615 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007616
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007617 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
7618 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
7619 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
7620 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
7621 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7622
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007623 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007624 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007625
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007626 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7627 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7628 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007629
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007630
7631option log-separate-errors
7632no option log-separate-errors
7633 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7635 yes | yes | yes | no
7636 Arguments : none
7637
7638 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7639 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7640 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7641 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7642 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7643 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7644 provides very important information.
7645
7646 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7647 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7648 error logs.
7649
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007650 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007651 logging.
7652
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007653
7654option logasap
7655no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007656 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7658 yes | yes | yes | no
7659 Arguments : none
7660
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007661 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
7662 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
7663 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
7664 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
7665
7666 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
7667 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
7668 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
7669 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
7670 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
7671 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transfered
7672 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
7673 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
7674 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
7675 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
7676 transfered.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007677
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007678 Examples :
7679 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7680 mode http
7681 option httplog
7682 option logasap
7683 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7684
7685 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7686 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7687 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7688 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007690 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007691 logging.
7692
7693
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007694option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007695 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7697 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007698 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007699 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7700 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007701 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007702
7703 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7704 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007705 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007706 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7707 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7708 in the MySQL table, like this :
7709
7710 USE mysql;
7711 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7712 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7713
7714 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007715 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007716 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7717 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7718 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7719 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7720 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7721 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7722 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7723
7724 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7725 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007726
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007727 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007728
7729 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7730 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7731 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7732 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007733 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7734 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007735
7736 See also: "option httpchk"
7737
7738
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007739option nolinger
7740no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007741 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007742 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7743 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007744 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007745
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007746 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007747 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7748 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7749 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7750 connections.
7751
7752 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7753 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7754 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7755 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7756 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7757 this too.
7758
7759 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7760 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7761 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7762
7763 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7764 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7765 for servers.
7766
7767 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7768 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7769
7770
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007771option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7772 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7774 yes | yes | yes | yes
7775 Arguments :
7776 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7777 matching <network>
7778 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7779 header name.
7780
7781 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7782 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7783 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7784 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7785 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7786 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7787 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7788 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7789 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7790 possible that the client has already brought one.
7791
7792 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7793 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7794 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7795 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7796 header and requires different one.
7797
7798 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7799 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7800 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7801 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7802 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7803 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7804 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7805
7806 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7807 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7808 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7809 both are defined.
7810
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007811 Examples :
7812 # Original Destination address
7813 frontend www
7814 mode http
7815 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7816
7817 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7818 backend www
7819 mode http
7820 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7821
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007822 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007823
7824
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007825option persist
7826no option persist
7827 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7828 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7829 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007830 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007831
7832 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7833 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7834 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7835 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7836 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7837 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7838 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7839 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7840 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7841 redirected to another valid server.
7842
7843 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7844 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7845
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007846 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007847
7848
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007849option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7850 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7852 yes | no | yes | yes
7853 Arguments :
7854 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7855 PostgreSQL server.
7856
7857 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7858 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7859 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7860 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7861
7862 See also: "option httpchk"
7863
7864
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007865option prefer-last-server
7866no option prefer-last-server
7867 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7868 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7869 yes | no | yes | yes
7870 Arguments : none
7871
7872 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7873 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7874 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7875 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7876 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7877 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7878 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7879 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7880 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007881 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7882 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007883 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7884 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7885 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007886 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7887 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7888 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007889
7890 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7891 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7892
7893 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7894
7895
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007896option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007897option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007898no option redispatch
7899 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7900 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7901 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007902 Arguments :
7903 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7904 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7905 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007906 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007907 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007908 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007909 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7910 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7911 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7912
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007913
7914 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7915 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7916 be able to access the service anymore.
7917
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007918 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7919 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007920
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02007921 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
7922 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
7923 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
7924 following order:
7925
7926 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
7927
7928 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
7929 list, or
7930
7931 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
7932
7933 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
7934 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
7935
7936 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
7937 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
7938 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
7939 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
7940
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007941 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007942 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7943 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007944
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007945 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7946 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7947
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007948 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007949
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007950
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007951option redis-check
7952 Use redis health checks for server testing
7953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7954 yes | no | yes | yes
7955 Arguments : none
7956
7957 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7958 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7959 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7960 find the "+PONG" response message.
7961
7962 Example :
7963 option redis-check
7964
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007965 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007966
7967
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007968option smtpchk
7969option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7970 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7972 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007973 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007974 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007975 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007976 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7977
7978 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7979 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7980 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7981
7982 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7983 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7984 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7985 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7986 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7987 dead server.
7988
7989 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7990 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007991 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007992 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7993
7994 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7995 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7996 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7997 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007998 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007999
8000 Example :
8001 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8002
8003 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8004
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008005
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008006option socket-stats
8007no option socket-stats
8008
8009 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8011 yes | yes | yes | no
8012
8013 Arguments : none
8014
8015
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008016option splice-auto
8017no option splice-auto
8018 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8020 yes | yes | yes | yes
8021 Arguments : none
8022
8023 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8024 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008025 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008026 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008027 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008028 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8029 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8030 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8031 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8032
8033 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8034 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8035 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8036 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8037 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8038 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8039 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8040 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8041 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8042 keyword.
8043
8044 Example :
8045 option splice-auto
8046
8047 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8048 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8049
8050 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8051 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8052
8053
8054option splice-request
8055no option splice-request
8056 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8058 yes | yes | yes | yes
8059 Arguments : none
8060
8061 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008062 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008063 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8064 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8065 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8066 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8067
8068 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8069
8070 Example :
8071 option splice-request
8072
8073 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8074 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8075
8076 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8077 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8078
8079
8080option splice-response
8081no option splice-response
8082 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8084 yes | yes | yes | yes
8085 Arguments : none
8086
8087 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008088 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008089 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8090 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8091 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8092 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8093
8094 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8095
8096 Example :
8097 option splice-response
8098
8099 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8100 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8101
8102 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8103 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8104
8105
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008106option spop-check
8107 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8109 no | no | no | yes
8110 Arguments : none
8111
8112 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8113 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8114 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8115 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8116
8117 Example :
8118 option spop-check
8119
8120 See also : "option httpchk"
8121
8122
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008123option srvtcpka
8124no option srvtcpka
8125 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8127 yes | no | yes | yes
8128 Arguments : none
8129
8130 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8131 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008132 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008133 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8134
8135 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8136 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8137 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8138 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8139
8140 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8141 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8142 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8143 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8144 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8145
8146 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8147
8148 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8149 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8150 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8151
8152 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8153 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8154
8155 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8156
8157
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008158option ssl-hello-chk
8159 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8161 yes | no | yes | yes
8162 Arguments : none
8163
8164 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8165 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8166 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8167 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8168 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8169 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8170 hello message.
8171
8172 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8173 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8174 messages, which is appreciable.
8175
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008176 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8177 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8178 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008179
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008180 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8181
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008182
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008183option tcp-check
8184 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8185 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8186 yes | no | yes | yes
8187
8188 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
8189 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
8190
8191 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
8192 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
8193 attempt, which remains the default mode.
8194
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008195 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008196 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
8197 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
8198 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
8199 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
8200 only.
8201
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008202 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008203 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
8204 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
8205 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
8206 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
8207
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008208 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008209 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
8210 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008211 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008212 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
8213 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
8214 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
8215 the respective protocols.
8216 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008217 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008218
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008219 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008220
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008221 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
8222 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
8223 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
8224 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008225
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008226 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
8227 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
8228 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01008229
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008230
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008231 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008232 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008233 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008234 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008235
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008236 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008237 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008238 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008239
8240 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8241 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008242 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008243 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008244 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008245 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008246 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008247 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008248 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8249 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008250 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008251 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8252 tcp-check expect string +OK
8253
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008254 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008255 (send many headers before analyzing)
8256 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008257 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008258 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8259 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8260 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8261 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008262 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008263
8264
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008265 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008266
8267
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008268option tcp-smart-accept
8269no option tcp-smart-accept
8270 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8272 yes | yes | yes | no
8273 Arguments : none
8274
8275 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8276 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8277 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8278 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8279 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8280 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8281
8282 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8283 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8284 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8285 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8286
8287 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8288 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8289 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008290 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008291
8292 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8293 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8294 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8295
8296 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8297 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8298 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8299
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008300 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8301
8302
8303option tcp-smart-connect
8304no option tcp-smart-connect
8305 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8307 yes | no | yes | yes
8308 Arguments : none
8309
8310 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8311 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8312 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8313 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8314 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8315
8316 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8317 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8318 complex.
8319
8320 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8321 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8322 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8323
8324 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8325 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8326
8327 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8328
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008329
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008330option tcpka
8331 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8333 yes | yes | yes | yes
8334 Arguments : none
8335
8336 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8337 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008338 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008339 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8340
8341 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8342 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8343 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8344 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8345
8346 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8347 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8348 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8349 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8350 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8351
8352 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8353
8354 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8355 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8356 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8357 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8358 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8359 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8360 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8361 backends.
8362
8363 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8364
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008365
8366option tcplog
8367 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008369 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008370 Arguments : none
8371
8372 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8373 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8374 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8375 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8376 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8377 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8378 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8379 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8380
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008381 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8382
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008383 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008384
8385
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008386option transparent
8387no option transparent
8388 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008390 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008391 Arguments : none
8392
8393 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8394 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8395 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8396 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8397 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8398 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8399 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8400 appropriate server.
8401
8402 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8403 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8404
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008405 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008406 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008407
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008408
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008409external-check command <command>
8410 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8412 yes | no | yes | yes
8413
8414 Arguments :
8415 <command> is the external command to run
8416
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008417 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8418
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008419 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008420
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008421 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8422 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8423 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8424 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8425 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8426 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008427
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008428 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8429
8430 Environment variables :
8431 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8432 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8433
8434 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8435
8436 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8437
8438 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8439 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8440 for a UNIX socket).
8441
8442 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8443
8444 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8445
8446 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8447
8448 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8449
8450 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8451
8452 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8453 socket).
8454
8455 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8456 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8457
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008458 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8459
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008460 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8461 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8462 failed.
8463
8464 Example :
8465 external-check command /bin/true
8466
8467 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
8468
8469
8470external-check path <path>
8471 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
8472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8473 yes | no | yes | yes
8474
8475 Arguments :
8476 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
8477
8478 The default path is "".
8479
8480 Example :
8481 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
8482
8483 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
8484 "external-check command"
8485
8486
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008487persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008488persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008489 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
8490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8491 yes | no | yes | yes
8492 Arguments :
8493 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008494 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
8495 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008496
8497 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
8498 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008499 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008500 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
8501 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
8502 forwarded to this server.
8503
8504 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
8505 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
8506 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008507 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008508 a single "listen" section.
8509
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008510 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
8511 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
8512 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
8513
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008514 Example :
8515 listen tse-farm
8516 bind :3389
8517 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8518 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8519 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8520 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8521 persist rdp-cookie
8522 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008523 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008524 balance rdp-cookie
8525 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8526 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
8527
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008528 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
8529 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008530
8531
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008532rate-limit sessions <rate>
8533 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
8534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8535 yes | yes | yes | no
8536 Arguments :
8537 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
8538 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
8539
8540 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
8541 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
8542 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
8543 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
8544 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
8545 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
8546
8547 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
8548 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
8549 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
8550 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
8551
8552 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
8553 listen smtp
8554 mode tcp
8555 bind :25
8556 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02008557 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008558
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02008559 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
8560 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
8561 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008562
8563 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
8564
8565
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008566redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8567redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8568redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008569 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
8570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8571 no | yes | yes | yes
8572
8573 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01008574 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008575
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008576 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008577 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008578 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
8579 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
8580 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008581
8582 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
8583 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
8584 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
8585 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
8586 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008587 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
8588 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
8589 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
8590 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008591
8592 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
8593 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
8594 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
8595 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
8596 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
8597 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008598 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008599 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008600 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
8601 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
8602 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008603
8604 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008605 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
8606 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
8607 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02008608 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008609 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
8610 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
8611 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
8612 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008613
8614 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008615 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008616
8617 - "drop-query"
8618 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
8619 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
8620 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
8621 with a location-type redirect.
8622
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008623 - "append-slash"
8624 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
8625 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
8626 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
8627 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
8628
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008629 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
8630 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
8631 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
8632 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
8633 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
8634 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
8635 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
8636
8637 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
8638 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
8639 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
8640 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
8641 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
8642 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8643 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008644
8645 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8646 acl clear dst_port 80
8647 acl secure dst_port 8080
8648 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008649 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008650 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008651 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8652
8653 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008654 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8655 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8656 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008657 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008658
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008659 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8660 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8661 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8662
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008663 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008664 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008665
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008666 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008667 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8668 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8669 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008670
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008671 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008672
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008673
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008674retries <value>
8675 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8676 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8677 yes | no | yes | yes
8678 Arguments :
8679 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8680 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8681 default value is 3.
8682
8683 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8684 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8685 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8686
8687 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008688 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8689 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008690
8691 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8692 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8693
8694 See also : "option redispatch"
8695
8696
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008697retry-on [list of keywords]
8698 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8699 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8700 yes | no | yes | yes
8701 Arguments :
8702 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8703 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8704 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8705 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8706
8707 none never retry
8708
8709 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8710 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8711
8712 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8713 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8714 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8715 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8716 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8717 processing the request.
8718
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008719 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8720 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8721 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8722 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8723 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8724 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8725 overflow attack for example).
8726
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008727 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8728 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8729 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8730 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8731 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8732 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8733 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8734 amplify denial of service attacks.
8735
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008736 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8737 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8738 considered to be safe to retry.
8739
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008740 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8741 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8742 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8743 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8744
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008745 all-retryable-errors
8746 retry request for any error that are considered
8747 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8748 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8749 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8750
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008751 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8752 not cumulative.
8753
8754 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8755 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8756 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8757 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8758
8759 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8760 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8761 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8762 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8763 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8764 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8765 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8766 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8767 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8768 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8769 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8770 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8771
8772 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8773 should not use this directive.
8774
8775 The default is "conn-failure".
8776
8777 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8778
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008779server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008780 Declare a server in a backend
8781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8782 no | no | yes | yes
8783 Arguments :
8784 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008785 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008786 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008787
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008788 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8789 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8790 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8791 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008792 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8793 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8794 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8795 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8796 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008797 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8798 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8799 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8800 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8801 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8802 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8803 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008804 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008805 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8806 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8807 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8808 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8809 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8810 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008811 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8812 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008813 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8814 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008815
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008816 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008817 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8818 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8819 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8820 adding this value to the client's port.
8821
8822 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8823 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008824 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008825
8826 Examples :
8827 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8828 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008829 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008830 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8831 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8832 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008833
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008834 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8835 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8836 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8837 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8838 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8839
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008840 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8841 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008842
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008843server-state-file-name [<file>]
8844 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8845 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8846 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8847 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8848 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8849 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8850
8851 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8852 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8853
8854 global
8855 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8856
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01008857 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008858 load-server-state-from-file
8859
8860 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8861 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008862
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008863server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8864 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8865 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8867 no | no | yes | yes
8868
8869 Arguments:
8870 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8871
8872 <num | range>
8873 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8874 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8875 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8876 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8877
8878 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8879
8880 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8881
8882 <params*>
8883 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8884 keyword.
8885
8886 Examples:
8887 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8888 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8889 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8890
8891 # or
8892 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8893
8894 # would be equivalent to:
8895 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8896 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8897 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8898
8899
8900
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008901source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008902source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008903source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008904 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8906 yes | no | yes | yes
8907 Arguments :
8908 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8909 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008910
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008911 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008912 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8913 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8914 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8915 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8916 supported prefixes are :
8917 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8918 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8919 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008920 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008921 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8922 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008923
8924 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8925 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008926 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8927 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8928 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008929
8930 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8931 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8932 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8933 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8934 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8935 <addr>.
8936
8937 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8938 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8939 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8940 port.
8941
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008942 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8943 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8944 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8945 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008946 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008947 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8948 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8949 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8950 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8951 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8952 HTTP header.
8953
8954 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8955 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008956 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008957 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8958 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8959 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8960 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8961 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8962 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8963 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8964
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008965 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8966 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8967 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8968 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8969 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8970 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8971
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008972 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8973 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8974 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8975 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8976
8977 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8978 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8979 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8980 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8981 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8982 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8983
8984 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8985 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8986 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8987 there are two methods :
8988
8989 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8990 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8991 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8992 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8993 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8994 of the client ranges may be used.
8995
8996 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8997 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8998 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8999 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9000 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9001 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9002 same session.
9003
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009004 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9005 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9006 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009007 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009008
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009009 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9010
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009011 Examples :
9012 backend private
9013 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9014 source 192.168.1.200
9015
9016 backend transparent_ssl1
9017 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9018 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9019
9020 backend transparent_ssl2
9021 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9022 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9023 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9024
9025 backend transparent_ssl3
9026 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9027 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9028 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9029
9030 backend transparent_smtp
9031 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9032 # with Tproxy version 4.
9033 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9034
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009035 backend transparent_http
9036 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9037 # proxy.
9038 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9039
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009040 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009041 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9042
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009043
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009044stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9045 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009047 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009048
9049 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9050 matched.
9051
9052 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9053 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9054
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009055 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9056 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009057 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009058
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009059 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9060 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9061 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9062 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009063
9064 Example :
9065 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9066 backend stats_localhost
9067 stats enable
9068 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9069
9070 Example :
9071 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9072 backend stats_auth
9073 stats enable
9074 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9075 stats admin if TRUE
9076
9077 Example :
9078 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9079 userlist stats-auth
9080 group admin users admin
9081 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9082 group readonly users haproxy
9083 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9084
9085 backend stats_auth
9086 stats enable
9087 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9088 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9089 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9090 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9091
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009092 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9093 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9094 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009095
9096
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009097stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9098 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009100 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009101 Arguments :
9102 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9103
9104 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9105
9106 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9107 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9108 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9109 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9110 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9111 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9112
9113 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9114 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9115 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009116 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009117
9118 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9119 report using "stats scope".
9120
9121 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9122 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9123 unobvious parameters.
9124
9125 Example :
9126 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9127 backend public_www
9128 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9129 stats enable
9130 stats hide-version
9131 stats scope .
9132 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009133 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009134 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9135 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9136
9137 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9138 backend private_monitoring
9139 stats enable
9140 stats uri /admin?stats
9141 stats refresh 5s
9142
9143 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
9144
9145
9146stats enable
9147 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
9148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009149 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009150 Arguments : none
9151
9152 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
9153 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
9154 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
9155 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
9156 - stats auth : no authentication
9157 - stats scope : no restriction
9158
9159 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9160 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9161 unobvious parameters.
9162
9163 Example :
9164 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9165 backend public_www
9166 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9167 stats enable
9168 stats hide-version
9169 stats scope .
9170 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009171 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009172 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9173 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9174
9175 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9176 backend private_monitoring
9177 stats enable
9178 stats uri /admin?stats
9179 stats refresh 5s
9180
9181 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9182
9183
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009184stats hide-version
9185 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009187 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009188 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009189
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009190 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9191 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9192 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9193 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9194 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9195 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009196
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009197 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9198 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9199 unobvious parameters.
9200
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009201 Example :
9202 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9203 backend public_www
9204 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009205 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009206 stats hide-version
9207 stats scope .
9208 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009209 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009210 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9211 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009212
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009213 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9214 backend private_monitoring
9215 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009216 stats uri /admin?stats
9217 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009218
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009219 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009220
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009221
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009222stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9223 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9224 Access control for statistics
9225
9226 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9227 no | no | yes | yes
9228
9229 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9230 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9231 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9232 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9233 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9234 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9235
9236 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9237 instance.
9238
9239 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9240 about ACL usage.
9241
9242
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009243stats realm <realm>
9244 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009246 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009247 Arguments :
9248 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9249 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9250 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9251
9252 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9253 using a backslash ('\').
9254
9255 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9256 only related to authentication.
9257
9258 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9259 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9260 unobvious parameters.
9261
9262 Example :
9263 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9264 backend public_www
9265 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9266 stats enable
9267 stats hide-version
9268 stats scope .
9269 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009270 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009271 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9272 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9273
9274 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9275 backend private_monitoring
9276 stats enable
9277 stats uri /admin?stats
9278 stats refresh 5s
9279
9280 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9281
9282
9283stats refresh <delay>
9284 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009286 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009287 Arguments :
9288 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9289 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9290 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9291 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9292 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9293 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9294
9295 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9296 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9297 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9298 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9299
9300 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9301 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9302 unobvious parameters.
9303
9304 Example :
9305 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9306 backend public_www
9307 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9308 stats enable
9309 stats hide-version
9310 stats scope .
9311 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009312 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009313 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9314 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9315
9316 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9317 backend private_monitoring
9318 stats enable
9319 stats uri /admin?stats
9320 stats refresh 5s
9321
9322 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9323
9324
9325stats scope { <name> | "." }
9326 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009328 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009329 Arguments :
9330 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9331 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9332 section in which the statement appears.
9333
9334 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9335 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9336 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9337 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9338 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9339 exists.
9340
9341 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9342 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9343 unobvious parameters.
9344
9345 Example :
9346 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9347 backend public_www
9348 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9349 stats enable
9350 stats hide-version
9351 stats scope .
9352 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009353 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009354 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9355 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9356
9357 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9358 backend private_monitoring
9359 stats enable
9360 stats uri /admin?stats
9361 stats refresh 5s
9362
9363 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9364
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009365
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009366stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009367 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009369 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009370
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009371 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009372 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9373
9374 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9375 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9376
9377 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9378 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009379 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009380
9381 Example :
9382 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9383 backend private_monitoring
9384 stats enable
9385 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9386 stats uri /admin?stats
9387 stats refresh 5s
9388
9389 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9390 global section.
9391
9392
9393stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009394 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9396 yes | yes | yes | yes
9397 Arguments : none
9398
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009399 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009400 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9401 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9402 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9403 - IP (socket, server)
9404 - cookie (backend, server)
9405
9406 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9407 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009408 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009409
9410 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9411
9412
9413stats show-node [ <name> ]
9414 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009416 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009417 Arguments:
9418 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9419 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9420
9421 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9422 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009423 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009424
9425 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9426 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9427 unobvious parameters.
9428
9429 Example:
9430 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9431 backend private_monitoring
9432 stats enable
9433 stats show-node Europe-1
9434 stats uri /admin?stats
9435 stats refresh 5s
9436
9437 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9438 section.
9439
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009440
9441stats uri <prefix>
9442 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009444 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009445 Arguments :
9446 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9447 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9448 query string.
9449
9450 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9451 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9452 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9453 possible to reach it in the application.
9454
9455 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009456 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009457 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9458 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9459 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9460 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9461
9462 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9463 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9464 an address or a port to statistics only.
9465
9466 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9467 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9468 unobvious parameters.
9469
9470 Example :
9471 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9472 backend public_www
9473 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9474 stats enable
9475 stats hide-version
9476 stats scope .
9477 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009478 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009479 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9480 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9481
9482 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9483 backend private_monitoring
9484 stats enable
9485 stats uri /admin?stats
9486 stats refresh 5s
9487
9488 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9489
9490
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009491stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9492 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009494 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009495
9496 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009497 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009498 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009499 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009500 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9501
9502 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9503 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9504 the "stick-table" statement.
9505
9506 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9507 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9508 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9509 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9510 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9511
9512 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9513 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9514 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9515 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9516 transformation rules.
9517
9518 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9519 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9520 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9521 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9522 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9523 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9524 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9525
9526 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9527 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9528 ACL based conditions.
9529
9530 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9531 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9532 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9533 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9534
9535 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9536 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9537 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9538 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9539
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009540 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9541 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009542 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009543
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009544 Example :
9545 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9546 # last 30 minutes
9547 backend pop
9548 mode tcp
9549 balance roundrobin
9550 stick store-request src
9551 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9552 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9553 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9554
9555 backend smtp
9556 mode tcp
9557 balance roundrobin
9558 stick match src table pop
9559 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9560 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9561
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009562 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009563 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009564
9565
9566stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9567 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9569 no | no | yes | yes
9570
9571 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9572 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9573 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9574 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9575
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009576 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9577 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009578 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009579
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009580 Examples :
9581 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009582 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009583
9584 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9585 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9586 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9587
9588
9589 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9590 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9591 backend http
9592 mode http
9593 balance roundrobin
9594 stick on src table https
9595 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9596 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9597 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9598
9599 backend https
9600 mode tcp
9601 balance roundrobin
9602 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9603 stick on src
9604 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9605 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9606
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009607 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009608
9609
9610stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9611 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9613 no | no | yes | yes
9614
9615 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009616 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009617 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009618 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009619 server is selected.
9620
9621 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9622 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9623 the "stick-table" statement.
9624
9625 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9626 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9627 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9628 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9629 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9630 address.
9631
9632 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9633 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9634 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9635 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9636 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9637 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9638 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9639 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9640 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9641 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9642
9643 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9644 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9645 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9646 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9647 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9648 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9649 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9650
9651 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9652 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9653 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9654 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9655
9656 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9657 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9658 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9659 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9660 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9661 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009662 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9663 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9664 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9665 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9666 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9667 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009668
9669 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9670 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9671 the request.
9672
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009673 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9674 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009675 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009676
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009677 Example :
9678 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9679 # last 30 minutes
9680 backend pop
9681 mode tcp
9682 balance roundrobin
9683 stick store-request src
9684 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9685 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9686 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9687
9688 backend smtp
9689 mode tcp
9690 balance roundrobin
9691 stick match src table pop
9692 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9693 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9694
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009695 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009696 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009697
9698
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009699stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009700 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9701 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009702 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009704 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009705
9706 Arguments :
9707 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9708 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9709 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9710 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9711
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009712 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9713 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9714 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9715 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9716
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009717 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9718 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9719 instance.
9720
9721 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9722 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9723 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9724 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9725 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9726 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009727 to 32 characters.
9728
9729 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9730 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9731 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009732 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009733 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9734 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009735
9736 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009737 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9738 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009739 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9740 increase.
9741
9742 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009743 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9744 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9745 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009746
9747 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9748 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9749 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9750 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009751 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009752 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9753 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9754 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9755 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9756 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9757 parameter (see below).
9758
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009759 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9760 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9761 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9762 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9763 soft restart.
9764
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009765 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9766 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009767
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009768 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9769 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9770 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9771 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009772 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009773 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009774 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9775 if not expiration delay is specified.
9776
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009777 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9778 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9779 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9780 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009781 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9782 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9783 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9784 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9785 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9786 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9787 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9788 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9789 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9790 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9791 types and their arguments.
9792
9793 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9794 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9795 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9796 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9797
9798 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9799 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9800 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009801 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009802
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009803 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9804 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9805 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009806 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009807 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009808 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009809
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009810 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9811 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9812 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9813 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9814
9815 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9816 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9817 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9818 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9819 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9820 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9821
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009822 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9823 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9824 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9825 they were received.
9826
9827 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9828 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9829 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9830 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9831 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9832
9833 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9834 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9835 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9836 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9837 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9838
9839 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9840 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9841 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9842
9843 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9844 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9845 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9846 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9847 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9848
9849 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9850 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9851 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9852 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9853 the client side.
9854
9855 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9856 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9857 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9858 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9859 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9860 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9861 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9862
9863 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9864 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9865 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9866 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9867 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9868 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009869 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009870
9871 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9872 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9873 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9874 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9875 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9876 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9877
9878 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009879 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009880 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9881 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9882
9883 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9884 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9885 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9886 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9887 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9888 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9889 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9890 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9891 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9892 recommended for better fairness.
9893
9894 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009895 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009896 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9897 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9898
9899 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9900 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9901 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9902 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9903 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9904 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9905 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9906 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9907 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9908 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009909
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009910 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9911 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009912 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9913 reference it.
9914
9915 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9916 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009917 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9918 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9919 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009920
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009921 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9922 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9923 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9924 something that can be ignored.
9925
9926 Example:
9927 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9928 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9929 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9930 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9931
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009932 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009933 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009934
9935
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009936stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009937 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9939 no | no | yes | yes
9940
9941 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009942 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009943 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009944 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009945 server is selected.
9946
9947 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9948 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9949 the "stick-table" statement.
9950
9951 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9952 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9953 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9954 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9955
9956 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9957 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9958 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9959 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9960 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9961 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009962 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009963 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9964 rules.
9965
9966 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9967 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9968 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9969 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9970 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9971 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9972 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9973
9974 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9975 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9976 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9977 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9978
9979 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9980 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9981 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9982 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9983 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9984 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009985 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9986 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9987 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9988 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9989 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9990 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9991 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9992 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9993 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009994
9995 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9996
9997 Example :
9998 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9999 backend https
10000 mode tcp
10001 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010002 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010003 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010004
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010005 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10006 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10007
10008 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10009 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10010 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10011
10012 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10013 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010014
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010015 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10016 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10017 # at offset 44.
10018
10019 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10020 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10021
10022 # Learn on response if server hello.
10023 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010024
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010025 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10026 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10027
10028 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10029 extraction.
10030
10031
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010032tcp-check comment <string>
10033 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10034 it fails.
10035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10036 yes | no | yes | yes
10037
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010038 Arguments :
10039 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10040 rule fails.
10041
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010042 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10043 user-friendly error reporting.
10044
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010045 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10046 "tcp-check expect".
10047
10048
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010049tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10050 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010051 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010052 Opens a new connection
10053 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010054 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010055
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010056 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010057 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10058
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010059 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Christopher Fauletbb591a12020-04-01 16:52:17 +020010060 checks. The server options are used only if not redifined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010061
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010062 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010063 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10064 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010065 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010066
10067 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010068
10069 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10070
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010071 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10072
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010073 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10074
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010075 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10076
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010077 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10078 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10079 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10080 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10081
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010082 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10083 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10084 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10085 haproxy -vv.
10086
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010087 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010088
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010089 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10090 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10091 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10092
10093 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10094 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10095 of the sequence.
10096
10097 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10098 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10099 do.
10100
10101 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10102 unset-var or comment rules.
10103
10104 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010105 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10106 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10107 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10108 option tcp-check
10109 tcp-check connect
10110 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10111 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10112 tcp-check send \r\n
10113 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10114 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
10115 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10116 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10117 tcp-check send \r\n
10118 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10119 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
10120
10121 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
10122 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010123 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010124 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10125 tcp-check connect port 143
10126 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10127 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
10128
10129 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
10130
10131
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010132tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010133 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010134 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010135 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010136 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010137 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010138 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010139
10140 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010141 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10142
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010143 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
10144 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
10145 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
10146 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
10147 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
10148 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
10149 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
10150 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
10151 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
10152 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
10153
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010154 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010155 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
10156 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010157 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
10158 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
10159 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
10160
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010161 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10162 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
10163 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
10164 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported and may be used to set,
10165 respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7OK, HCHK_STATUS_L7OKCD,
10166 HCHK_STATUS_L6OK or HCHK_STATUS_L4OK success status.
10167 By default "L7OK" is used.
10168
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010169 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10170 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
10171 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported and
10172 may be used to set, respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7RSP,
10173 HCHK_STATUS_L7STS, HCHK_STATUS_L6RSP or HCHK_STATUS_L4CON
10174 error status. By default "L7RSP" is used.
10175
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010176 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010177 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
10178 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported and may
10179 be used to set, respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7TOUT,
10180 HCHK_STATUS_L6TOUT or HCHK_STATUS_L4TOUT timeout status.
10181 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
10182
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020010183 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10184 informational message reported in logs if the expect
10185 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
10186 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
10187
10188 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10189 informational message reported in logs if an error
10190 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
10191 log-format string.
10192
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010193 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
10194 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
10195 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10196 followed by some converters.
10197
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010198 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
10199 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
10200 with the usual backslash ('\').
10201 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010202 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010203 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
10204 used upper or lower case.
10205
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010206 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
10207
10208 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
10209 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10210 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
10211 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10212 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
10213 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
10214 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
10215 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
10216
10217 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
10218 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10219 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
10220 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10221 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
10222 expression.
10223
10224 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
10225 in the response buffer. A health check response will
10226 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
10227 this exact hexadecimal string.
10228 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
10229
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010230 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
10231 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
10232 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
10233 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
10234 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
10235 size of the original response. As such, the expected
10236 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
10237 size.
10238
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010239 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
10240 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
10241 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
10242 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
10243 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
10244 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
10245 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
10246 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
10247 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
10248 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
10249 the null character.
10250
10251 Examples :
10252 # perform a POP check
10253 option tcp-check
10254 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10255
10256 # perform an IMAP check
10257 option tcp-check
10258 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10259
10260 # look for the redis master server
10261 option tcp-check
10262 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010263 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010264 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10265 tcp-check expect string role:master
10266 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10267 tcp-check expect string +OK
10268
10269
10270 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
10271 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
10272
10273
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010274tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010275 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
10276 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010277 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010278
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010279 Arguments :
10280 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10281
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010282 <data> the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
10283 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010284
10285 Examples :
10286 # look for the redis master server
10287 option tcp-check
10288 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10289 tcp-check expect string role:master
10290
10291 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10292 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10293
10294
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010295tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010296 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010297 tcp health check
10298 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010299 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010300
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010301 Arguments :
10302 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010303
10304 <hexstring> test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
10305 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
10306 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact hexadecimal
10307 string. Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary
10308 protocols.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010309
10310 Examples :
10311 # redis check in binary
10312 option tcp-check
10313 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10314 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10315
10316
10317 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10318 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10319
10320
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010321tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010322 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010323 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010324 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010325
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010326 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010327 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10328 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10329 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10330 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10331 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10332 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10333 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10334 and '-'.
10335
10336 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
10337
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010338 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010339 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
10340
10341
10342tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010343 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010344 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010345 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010346
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010347 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010348 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10349 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10350 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10351 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10352 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10353 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10354 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10355 and '-'.
10356
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010357 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010358 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
10359
10360
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010361tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10362 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10364 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010365 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010366 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10367 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010368
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010369 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010370
10371 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10372 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010373 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10374 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10375 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10376 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10377 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10378 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010379
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010380 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10381 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10382 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10383 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010384
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010385 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010386 - accept :
10387 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10388 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10389 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010390
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010391 - reject :
10392 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10393 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10394 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10395 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
10396 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
10397 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
10398 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
10399 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
10400 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
10401 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
10402 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010403 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010404
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010405 - expect-proxy layer4 :
10406 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
10407 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
10408 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10409 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10410 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10411 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10412 hosts.
10413
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010414 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10415 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10416 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10417 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10418 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10419 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10420 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10421 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10422
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010423 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10424 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10425 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10426 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10427 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10428 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10429 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10430 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10431 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010432 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10433 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010434
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010435 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010436 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010437 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10438 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10439 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010440 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010441 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10442 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10443 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10444 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10445 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10446 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10447 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10448 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010449
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010450 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010451 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010452 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010453 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010454 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10455 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10456 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010457
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010458 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10459 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10460 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10461 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010462
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010463 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10464 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10465 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10466 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10467 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010468 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10469 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10470 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10471 layer7 information is extracted.
10472
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010473 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10474 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10475 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10476 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10477 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010478
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010479 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10480 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10481 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10482 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10483
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010484 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10485 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10486 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10487 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10488
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010489 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
10490 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10491 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10492 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10493 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010494
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010495 - set-src <expr> :
10496 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10497 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10498 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010499 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010500
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010501 Arguments:
10502 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10503 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010504
10505 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010506 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10507
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010508 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10509 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010510
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010511 - set-src-port <expr> :
10512 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10513 expression.
10514
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010515 Arguments:
10516 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10517 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010518
10519 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010520 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10521
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010522 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10523 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10524 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010525
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010526 - set-dst <expr> :
10527 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10528 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10529 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10530 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10531 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10532
10533 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10534 followed by some converters.
10535
10536 Example:
10537
10538 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10539 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10540
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010541 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10542 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10543
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010544 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10545 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10546 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10547 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10548
10549
10550 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10551 followed by some converters.
10552
10553 Example:
10554
10555 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10556
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010557 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10558 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10559 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10560
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010561 - "silent-drop" :
10562 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010563 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010564 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10565 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10566 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10567 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10568 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010569 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10570 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010571 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10572 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010573 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010574 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10575 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10576 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10577 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10578
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010579 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10580 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10581 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010582
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010583 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10584 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10585 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010586
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010587 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010588 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010589 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010590
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010591 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10592 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10593 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010594
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010595 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010596 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10597 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010598
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010599 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10600
10601 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10602
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010603 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10604
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010605 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010606
10607
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010608tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10609 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010611 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010612 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010613 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10614 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010615
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010616 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010617
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010618 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010619 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10620 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10621 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10622 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010623
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010624 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10625 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10626 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10627 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010628 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10629 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10630 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10631 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10632 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10633 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010634 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010635 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010636
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010637 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10638 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10639 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10640 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010641
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010642 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010643 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010644 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010645 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10646 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010647 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010648 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010649 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010650 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010651 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010652 - set-dst <expr>
10653 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010654 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010655 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010656 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010657 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010658 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010659
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010660 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10661 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010662 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10663 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010664
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010665 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10666 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10667 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10668 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10669 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10670 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010671
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010672 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010673 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10674 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010675
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010676 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010677 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10678 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10679 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10680 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010681 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10682 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10683 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010684
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010685 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010686 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10687 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10688 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010689
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010690 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10691 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10692
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010693 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010694 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10695 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010696
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010697 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10698 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010699 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010700 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10701 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010702 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010703 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010704 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010705 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10706 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010707 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010708 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10709 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010710
10711 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10712 followed by some converters.
10713
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010714 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10715 <var-name>.
10716
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010717 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10718 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10719 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10720 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10721 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10722
10723 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10724 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10725 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10726 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10727 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10728 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10729 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10730 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10731 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10732 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10733 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10734
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010735 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10736 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10737 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10738 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10739 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10740
10741 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10742
10743 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10744
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010745 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10746 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10747 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10748 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10749 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10750 evaluated.
10751
10752 Example:
10753 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10754
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010755 Example:
10756
10757 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010758 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010759
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010760 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010761 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10762 # and reject everything else.
10763 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10764 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010765 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010766 tcp-request content reject
10767
10768 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010769 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10770 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10771 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010772 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010773
10774 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10775 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10776 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010777 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010778 tcp-request content reject
10779
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010780 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010781 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010782 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010783 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010784 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10785 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010786
10787 Example:
10788 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10789 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010790 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010791
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010792 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010793 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010794
10795 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010796 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010797 # protecting all our sites
10798 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010799 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10800 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010801 ...
10802 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10803
10804 backend http_dynamic
10805 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010806 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010807 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010808 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010809 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010810 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010811 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010812
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010813 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010814
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010815 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10816 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010817
10818
10819tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10820 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010822 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010823 Arguments :
10824 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10825 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10826 as explained at the top of this document.
10827
10828 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10829 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10830 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10831 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10832 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10833
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010834 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10835 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10836 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10837 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10838
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010839 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10840 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010841 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010842 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010843 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10844 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10845 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10846 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010847
10848 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10849 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10850 it pass through unaffected.
10851
10852 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10853 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10854 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010855 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010856 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10857 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010858 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10859 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10860 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010861
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010862 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010863 "timeout client".
10864
10865
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010866tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10867 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10869 no | no | yes | yes
10870 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010871 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10872 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010873
10874 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10875
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010876 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010877 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10878 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010879 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10880 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010881
10882 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10883
10884 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10885 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10886 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10887 inserted.
10888
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010889 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010890 - accept :
10891 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10892 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10893 the rules evaluation.
10894
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010895 - close :
10896 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10897 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10898 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10899 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10900 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10901 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010902 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010903 protocols.
10904
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010905 - reject :
10906 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10907 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010908 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010909
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010910 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10911 Sets a variable.
10912
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010913 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10914 Unsets a variable.
10915
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010916 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10917 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10918 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10919 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10920
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010921 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10922 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10923 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10924 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10925
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010926 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
10927 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10928 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10929 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10930 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010931
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010932 - "silent-drop" :
10933 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010934 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010935 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10936 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10937 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10938 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10939 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010940 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10941 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010942 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10943 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010944 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010945 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10946 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10947 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10948 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10949
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010950 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10951 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10952
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010953 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10954 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10955 for changing the default action to a reject.
10956
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010957 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10958 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10959 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10960 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010961 period.
10962
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010963 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10964 declared inline.
10965
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010966 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10967 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010968 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010969 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10970 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010971 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010972 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010973 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010974 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10975 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010976 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010977 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10978 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010979
10980 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10981 followed by some converters.
10982
10983 Example:
10984
10985 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10986
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010987 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10988 <var-name>.
10989
10990 Example:
10991
10992 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10993
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010994 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10995 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10996 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10997 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10998 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10999
11000 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11001
11002 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11003
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011004 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11005
11006 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11007
11008
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011009tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11010 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11012 no | yes | yes | no
11013 Arguments :
11014 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11015 below.
11016
11017 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11018
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011019 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011020 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11021 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11022 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11023 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11024 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11025 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11026 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011027 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011028 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11029 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11030 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11031 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11032 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11033 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11034 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11035 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11036 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11037 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11038 instead.
11039
11040 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11041 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11042 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11043 rules which may be inserted.
11044
11045 Several types of actions are supported :
11046 - accept : the request is accepted
11047 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11048 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11049 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011050 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011051 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011052 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011053 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011054 - silent-drop
11055
11056 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11057 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11058 sections for a complete description.
11059
11060 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11061 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11062 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
11063
11064 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
11065 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
11066 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11067 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11068 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11069
11070 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11071 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11072
11073 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11074 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
11075 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
11076
11077 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11078 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
11079 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11080
11081 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
11082 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11083 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
11084
11085 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11086 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11087 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
11088
11089 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11090
11091 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
11092
11093
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011094tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
11095 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
11096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11097 no | no | yes | yes
11098 Arguments :
11099 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11100 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11101 as explained at the top of this document.
11102
11103 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
11104
11105
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011106timeout check <timeout>
11107 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
11108 established.
11109
11110 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11111 yes | no | yes | yes
11112 Arguments:
11113 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11114 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11115 as explained at the top of this document.
11116
11117 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
11118 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011119 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011120 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010011121 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
11122 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
11123 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011124
11125 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
11126 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
11127
11128 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
11129 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011130 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011131
11132 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11133 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11134 forget about it.
11135
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011136 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
11137 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011138
11139
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011140timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011141 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
11142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11143 yes | yes | yes | no
11144 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011145 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011146 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11147 as explained at the top of this document.
11148
11149 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11150 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11151 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010011152 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
11153 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
11154 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
11155 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011156 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
11157 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
11158 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011159 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011160 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011161 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
11162 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011163 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
11164 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011165
11166 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11167 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11168 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11169 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011170 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011171 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11172
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011173 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011174
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011175 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011176
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011177
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011178timeout client-fin <timeout>
11179 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
11180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11181 yes | yes | yes | no
11182 Arguments :
11183 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11184 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11185 as explained at the top of this document.
11186
11187 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11188 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11189 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11190 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11191 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
11192 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11193 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010011194 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
11195 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
11196 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011197
11198 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11199 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11200 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
11201
11202 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
11203
11204
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011205timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011206 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
11207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11208 yes | no | yes | yes
11209 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011210 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011211 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11212 as explained at the top of this document.
11213
11214 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011215 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011216 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011217 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011218 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
11219 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011220
11221 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11222 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11223 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11224 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011225 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011226 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11227
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011228 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011229
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011230
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011231timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
11232 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
11233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11234 yes | yes | yes | yes
11235 Arguments :
11236 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11237 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11238 as explained at the top of this document.
11239
11240 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
11241 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
11242 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
11243 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
11244 once the request has started to present itself.
11245
11246 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
11247 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
11248 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
11249 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
11250 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
11251
11252 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
11253 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
11254 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
11255 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
11256
11257 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
11258 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011259 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011260 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
11261 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011262 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011263
11264 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
11265 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
11266 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
11267 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
11268
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011269 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
11270 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011271 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
11272
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011273 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
11274
11275
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011276timeout http-request <timeout>
11277 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
11278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011279 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011280 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011281 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011282 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11283 as explained at the top of this document.
11284
11285 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
11286 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
11287 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
11288 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
11289 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
11290 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
11291 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020011292 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
11293 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
11294 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
11295 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011296 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011297 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
11298 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011299
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011300 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11301 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11302 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11303 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11304 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011305 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011306
11307 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11308 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011309 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011310 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
11311 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
11312
11313 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011314 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11315 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11316 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011317
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011318 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011319 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011320
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011321
11322timeout queue <timeout>
11323 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11325 yes | no | yes | yes
11326 Arguments :
11327 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11328 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11329 as explained at the top of this document.
11330
11331 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11332 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11333 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11334 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11335 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11336
11337 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11338 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11339 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11340 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11341
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011342 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011343
11344
11345timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011346 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11348 yes | no | yes | yes
11349 Arguments :
11350 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11351 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11352 as explained at the top of this document.
11353
11354 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11355 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11356 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11357 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11358 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11359 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11360 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11361
11362 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11363 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11364 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11365 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11366 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011367 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011368 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011369 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11370 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011371 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11372 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011373
11374 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11375 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11376 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11377 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011378 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011379 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11380
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011381 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011382
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011383
11384timeout server-fin <timeout>
11385 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11387 yes | no | yes | yes
11388 Arguments :
11389 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11390 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11391 as explained at the top of this document.
11392
11393 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11394 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11395 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11396 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11397 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11398 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11399 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11400 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11401 situations, it should not be needed.
11402
11403 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11404 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11405 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11406
11407 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11408
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011409
11410timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011411 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11413 yes | yes | yes | yes
11414 Arguments :
11415 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11416 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11417 as explained at the top of this document.
11418
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020011419 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
11420 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
11421 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011422
11423 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11424 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11425 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11426 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011427 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011428
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011429 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011430
11431
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011432timeout tunnel <timeout>
11433 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11435 yes | no | yes | yes
11436 Arguments :
11437 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11438 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11439 as explained at the top of this document.
11440
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011441 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011442 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11443 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11444 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011445 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11446 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011447 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11448 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11449 specified.
11450
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011451 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11452 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11453 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11454 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11455 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11456 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11457 state.
11458
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011459 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11460 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11461 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11462 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011463 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011464
11465 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11466 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11467 forget about it.
11468
11469 Example :
11470 defaults http
11471 option http-server-close
11472 timeout connect 5s
11473 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011474 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011475 timeout server 30s
11476 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11477
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011478 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011479
11480
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011481transparent (deprecated)
11482 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011484 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011485 Arguments : none
11486
11487 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11488 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11489 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11490 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11491 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11492 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11493 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11494 appropriate server.
11495
11496 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11497
11498 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11499 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11500
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011501 See also: "option transparent"
11502
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011503unique-id-format <string>
11504 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11506 yes | yes | yes | no
11507 Arguments :
11508 <string> is a log-format string.
11509
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011510 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11511 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11512 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11513 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011514
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011515 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11516 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11517 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11518 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11519 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11520 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11521 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11522 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011523
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011524 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11525 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011526
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011527 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011528
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011529 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011530
11531 will generate:
11532
11533 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11534
11535 See also: "unique-id-header"
11536
11537unique-id-header <name>
11538 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11540 yes | yes | yes | no
11541 Arguments :
11542 <name> is the name of the header.
11543
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011544 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11545 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011546
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011547 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011548
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011549 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011550 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11551
11552 will generate:
11553
11554 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11555
11556 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011557
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011558use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011559 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11561 no | yes | yes | no
11562 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011563 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11564 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011565
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011566 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11567 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011568
11569 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11570 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11571 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011572 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011573 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011574 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11575 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011576
11577 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11578 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11579 assign the backend.
11580
11581 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11582 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11583 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11584 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11585 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11586 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11587
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011588 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011589 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011590 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11591 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11592 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11593
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011594 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11595 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11596 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11597 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11598 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11599 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11600 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11601 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11602 cannot be forced from the request.
11603
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011604 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011605 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11606 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11607
11608 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11609 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011610
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011611use-fcgi-app <name>
11612 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
11613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11614 no | no | yes | yes
11615 Arguments :
11616 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
11617
11618 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011619
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011620use-server <server> if <condition>
11621use-server <server> unless <condition>
11622 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11624 no | no | yes | yes
11625 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011626 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
11627 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011628
11629 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11630
11631 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11632 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11633 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11634
11635 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11636 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11637 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11638 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11639 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11640 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11641 matches will assign the server.
11642
11643 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11644 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11645 with the next rules until one matches.
11646
11647 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11648 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11649 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11650 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11651
11652 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11653 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11654 stripped.
11655
11656 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11657 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11658 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11659 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11660
11661 Example :
11662 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11663 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11664 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11665 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11666 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11667 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011668 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011669 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11670 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11671
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011672 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
11673 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
11674 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
11675 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
11676 was conditionned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
11677 and we fall back to load balancing.
11678
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011679 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011680
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011681
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100116825. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011683--------------------------
11684
11685The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11686depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11687settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11688written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11689described in this section.
11690
11691
116925.1. Bind options
11693-----------------
11694
11695The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11696as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11697no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11698parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11699while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11700provided immediately after the setting name.
11701
11702The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11703
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011704accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11705 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11706 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11707 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11708 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11709 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11710 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11711 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11712 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11713 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011714 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11715 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11716 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011717
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011718accept-proxy
11719 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011720 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11721 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011722 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11723 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11724 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11725 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011726 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011727 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11728 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011729 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11730 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011731
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011732allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011733 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011734 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011735 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011736 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11737 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011738
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011739alpn <protocols>
11740 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11741 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11742 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011743 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011744 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011745 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11746 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11747 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11748 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11749 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11750 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11751 preference, like below :
11752
11753 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011754
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011755backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011756 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011757 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11758
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011759curves <curves>
11760 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11761 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11762 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11763 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11764 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11765 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11766
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011767ecdhe <named curve>
11768 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011769 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11770 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011771
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011772ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011773 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11774 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11775 client's certificate.
11776
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011777ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11778 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11779 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11780 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11781 error is ignored.
11782
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011783ca-sign-file <cafile>
11784 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11785 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11786 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11787 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11788 'generate-certificates' for details.
11789
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011790ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011791 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11792 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11793 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11794 'generate-certificates' for details.
11795
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011796ca-verify-file <cafile>
11797 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
11798 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
11799 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
11800 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
11801 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
11802
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011803ciphers <ciphers>
11804 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11805 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011806 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011807 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011808 information and recommendations see e.g.
11809 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11810 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11811 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11812
11813ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11814 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11815 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11816 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11817 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011818 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11819 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011820
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011821crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011822 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11823 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11824 to verify client's certificate.
11825
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011826crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011827 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11828 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11829 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11830 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11831 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010011832 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
11833 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011834
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010011835 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
11836 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
11837
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011838 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11839 are loaded.
11840
11841 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010011842 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
11843 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
11844 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
11845 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
11846 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
11847 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
11848 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011849 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011850
11851 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11852 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11853 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11854 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011855 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11856 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011857
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011858 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011859
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011860 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011861 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011862 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11863 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011864 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11865 clients).
11866
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011867 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11868 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11869 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11870 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11871 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11872 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11873 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11874 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11875 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11876 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11877 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11878 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11879 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11880
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011881 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11882 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11883 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11884 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11885 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11886
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011887 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11888 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11889 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11890 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011891
11892 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11893 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11894 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11895 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11896 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11897 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11898 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11899 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11900 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11901
11902 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11903
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011904 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011905 a cert bundle.
11906
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011907 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011908 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11909 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11910 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11911 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11912 provide multi-cert support.
11913
11914 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11915
11916 Filename | CN | SAN
11917 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11918 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011919 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011920 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11921 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11922
11923 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11924 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11925 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11926 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011927 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11928 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11929 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011930
11931 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11932 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11933
11934 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11935 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11936 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11937
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011938crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011939 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011940 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011941 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011942 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011943
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011944crt-list <file>
11945 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011946 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11947 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011948
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011949 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11950
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011951 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
11952 "no-ca-names", "crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With
11953 BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also
11954 supported. It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011955
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011956 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11957 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11958 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11959 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11960 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11961 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11962 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11963 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011964
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011965 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011966 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011967 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11968 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11969 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011970
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011971 crt-list file example:
11972 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011973 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011974 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011975 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011976
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011977defer-accept
11978 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11979 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11980 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011981 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011982 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11983 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11984 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11985 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11986 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11987 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11988 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11989
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011990expose-fd listeners
11991 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11992 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011993 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11994 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011995 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011996
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011997force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011998 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011999 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012000 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012001 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012002
12003force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012004 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012005 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012006 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012007
12008force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012009 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012010 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012011 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012012
12013force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012014 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012015 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012016 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012017
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012018force-tlsv13
12019 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12020 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012021 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012022
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012023generate-certificates
12024 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12025 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12026 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12027 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12028 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12029 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12030 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12031 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12032 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12033 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12034 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12035
12036 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12037 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012038 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012039 certificate is used many times.
12040
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012041gid <gid>
12042 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12043 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12044 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12045 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12046 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12047
12048group <group>
12049 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12050 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12051 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12052 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12053 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12054
12055id <id>
12056 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12057 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12058 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12059 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12060
12061interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012062 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12063 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12064 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12065 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12066 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12067 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012068 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12069 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12070 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12071 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12072 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12073 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012074
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012075level <level>
12076 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12077 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12078 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012079 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012080 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12081 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12082 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012083 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012084 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012085 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012086 all counters).
12087
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012088severity-output <format>
12089 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12090 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12091 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12092 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12093 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12094 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12095 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12096 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12097 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12098 rfc5424 convention.
12099
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012100maxconn <maxconn>
12101 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
12102 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
12103 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
12104 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
12105 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
12106 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
12107 eat all memory.
12108
12109mode <mode>
12110 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
12111 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
12112 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
12113 UNIX sockets.
12114
12115mss <maxseg>
12116 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
12117 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
12118 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
12119 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
12120 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
12121 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
12122 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
12123 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
12124 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
12125 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
12126 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
12127
12128name <name>
12129 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
12130 page.
12131
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012132namespace <name>
12133 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12134 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
12135 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12136 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12137
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012138nice <nice>
12139 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
12140 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
12141 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
12142 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
12143 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
12144 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
12145 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
12146 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
12147 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
12148 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
12149 one for an RDP socket.
12150
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012151no-ca-names
12152 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12153 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012154 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012155
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012156no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012157 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012158 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012159 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012160 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012161 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
12162 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012163
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012164no-tls-tickets
12165 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12166 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12167 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012168 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
12169 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012170 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12171 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12172 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012173
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012174no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012175 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012176 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012177 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012178 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012179 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12180 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012181
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012182no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012183 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012184 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012185 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012186 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012187 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12188 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012189
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012190no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012191 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012192 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012193 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012194 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012195 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12196 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012197
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012198no-tlsv13
12199 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12200 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
12201 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
12202 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012203 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12204 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012205
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012206npn <protocols>
12207 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12208 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12209 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012210 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012211 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012212 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12213 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
12214 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
12215 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
12216 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012217
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012218prefer-client-ciphers
12219 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
12220 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
12221 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020012222 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
12223 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
12224 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012225
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012226process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012227 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012228 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012229 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012230 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
12231 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
12232 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
12233 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012234 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012235 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
12236 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
12237 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
12238 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
12239 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012240
12241 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
12242
12243 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
12244 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
12245 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
12246 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
12247 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
12248 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
12249 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
12250 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020012251
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012252proto <name>
12253 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
12254 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
12255 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
12256 in haproxy -vv.
12257 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12258 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080012259 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012260 h2" on the bind line.
12261
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012262ssl
12263 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012264 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012265 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
12266 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020012267 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
12268 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012269
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012270ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12271 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
12272 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
12273 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12274
12275ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12276 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
12277 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
12278 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12279
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010012280strict-sni
12281 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
12282 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
12283 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
12284 See the "crt" option for more information.
12285
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012286tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012287 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012288 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
12289 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012290 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012291 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
12292 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
12293 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
12294 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
12295 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
12296 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
12297 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12298
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012299tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010012300 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012301 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12302 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12303 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12304 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12305 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12306 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12307 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012308 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12309 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12310 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012311
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012312tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12313 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012314 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12315 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12316 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12317 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12318 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12319 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12320 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12321 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12322 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12323 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012324 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12325 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12326
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012327transparent
12328 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12329 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12330 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12331 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12332 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12333 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12334 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12335 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12336 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12337 so check for support with your vendor.
12338
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012339v4v6
12340 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12341 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12342 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12343 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012344 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012345
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012346v6only
12347 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12348 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12349 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012350 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12351 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012352
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012353uid <uid>
12354 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12355 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12356 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12357 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12358 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12359
12360user <user>
12361 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12362 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12363 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12364 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12365 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12366
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012367verify [none|optional|required]
12368 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12369 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12370 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12371 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12372 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012373 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12374 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12375 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12376 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012377
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200123785.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012379------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012380
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012381The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12382which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12383arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12384settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12385after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12386Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12387address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012388
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012389 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012390 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012391
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012392Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
12393keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
12394
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012395The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012396
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012397addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012398 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010012399 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
12400 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
12401 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
12402 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
12403 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012404
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012405agent-check
12406 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012407 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010012408 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
12409 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
12410 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012411
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012412 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012413 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020012414 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
12415 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
12416 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012417
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012418 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
12419 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
12420 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12421 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12422 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012423
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012424 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012425 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012426
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012427 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12428 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12429 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012430
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012431 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12432 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12433 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012434
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012435 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12436 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12437 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12438 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12439 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012440 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012441 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012442
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012443 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12444 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012445
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012446 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12447 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12448 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12449 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12450 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12451 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12452 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12453 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12454 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012455
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012456 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12457 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012458 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12459 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12460 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012461 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012462
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012463 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012464 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012465
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012466agent-send <string>
12467 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12468 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12469 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12470 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12471 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12472
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012473agent-inter <delay>
12474 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12475 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12476
12477 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12478 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12479 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12480 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12481 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12482 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12483 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12484 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12485 of backends use the same servers.
12486
12487 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12488
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012489agent-addr <addr>
12490 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12491
12492 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12493 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12494 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12495 hostname, it will be resolved.
12496
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012497agent-port <port>
12498 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12499
12500 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12501
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012502allow-0rtt
12503 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012504 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12505 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012506
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012507alpn <protocols>
12508 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12509 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12510 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012511 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012512 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12513 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12514 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12515 now obsolete NPN extension.
12516 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12517 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12518
12519 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12520
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012521backup
12522 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12523 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12524 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12525 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012526 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12527 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012528
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012529ca-file <cafile>
12530 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12531 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12532 server's certificate.
12533
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012534check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020012535 This option enables health checks on a server:
12536 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
12537 considered available.
12538 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
12539 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
12540 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
12541 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
12542 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
12543 set.
12544 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
12545 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
12546 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
12547 exchanges succeed.
12548
12549 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
12550 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
12551 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
12552 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
12553 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
12554 parameters are not reused. One must explicitely set "check-send-proxy" to send
12555 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
12556
12557 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
12558 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
12559
12560 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
12561 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
12562
12563 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
12564 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
12565 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
12566 available.
12567
12568 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
12569 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
12570 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
12571
12572 Example:
12573 # simple tcp check
12574 backend foo
12575 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
12576 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
12577 backend foo
12578 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
12579 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
12580 backend foo
12581 option tcp-check
12582 tcp-check connect
12583 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012584
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012585check-send-proxy
12586 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12587 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12588 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12589 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12590 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12591 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12592 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12593
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012594check-alpn <protocols>
12595 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12596 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12597 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12598
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012599check-proto <name>
12600 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
12601 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
12602 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
12603 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
12604 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12605 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
12606 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
12607
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012608check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012609 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012610 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12611 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012612
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012613check-ssl
12614 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12615 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12616 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12617 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012618 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012619 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12620 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012621 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012622 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12623 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012624
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012625check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012626 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012627 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12628 for normal traffic.
12629
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012630ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012631 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12632 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12633 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012634 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12635 information and recommendations see e.g.
12636 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12637 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12638 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012639
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012640ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12641 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12642 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12643 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12644 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012645 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12646 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12647 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012648
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012649cookie <value>
12650 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12651 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12652 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12653 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12654 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12655 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12656 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12657
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012658crl-file <crlfile>
12659 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12660 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12661 to verify server's certificate.
12662
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012663crt <cert>
12664 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12665 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12666 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12667 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12668 certificate request.
12669
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012670disabled
12671 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12672 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12673 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12674 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12675 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012676 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012677
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012678enabled
12679 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12680 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12681 default value.
12682 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12683 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012684
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012685error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012686 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12687 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12688 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012689
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012690 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012691
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012692fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012693 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12694 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12695 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12696
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012697force-sslv3
12698 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12699 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012700 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012701 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012702
12703force-tlsv10
12704 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012705 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012706 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012707
12708force-tlsv11
12709 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012710 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012711 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012712
12713force-tlsv12
12714 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012715 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012716 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012717
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012718force-tlsv13
12719 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12720 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012721 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012722
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012723id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012724 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12725 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12726 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012727
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012728init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12729 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12730 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012731 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012732 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12733 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12734 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12735 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12736 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12737 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12738 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12739 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12740 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012741 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012742 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12743 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12744 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12745 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12746 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12747 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012748 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012749
12750 Example:
12751 defaults
12752 # never fail on address resolution
12753 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12754
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012755inter <delay>
12756fastinter <delay>
12757downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012758 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12759 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12760 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12761 between checks depending on the server state :
12762
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012763 Server state | Interval used
12764 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12765 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12766 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12767 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12768 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12769 or yet unchecked. |
12770 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12771 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12772 | "inter" otherwise.
12773 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012774
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012775 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12776 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12777 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12778 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012779 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12780 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12781 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12782 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12783 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012784
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012785maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012786 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12787 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012788 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12789 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012790 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12791 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12792 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12793 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12794
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012795 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12796 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12797 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12798 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12799 than 50 concurrent requests.
12800
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012801maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012802 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12803 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12804 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12805 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12806 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12807 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12808 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12809
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012810max-reuse <count>
12811 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12812 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12813 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12814 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12815 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12816 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12817 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12818 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12819
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012820minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012821 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12822 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12823 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12824 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12825 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12826 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012827 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012828 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012829
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012830namespace <name>
12831 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12832 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12833 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12834 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12835
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012836no-agent-check
12837 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12838 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12839 default value.
12840 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12841 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12842
12843no-backup
12844 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12845 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12846 default value.
12847 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12848 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12849
12850no-check
12851 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12852 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12853 default value.
12854 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12855 "default-server" "check" setting.
12856
12857no-check-ssl
12858 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12859 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12860 default value.
12861 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12862 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12863
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012864no-send-proxy
12865 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12866 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12867 default value.
12868 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12869 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12870
12871no-send-proxy-v2
12872 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12873 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12874 default value.
12875 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12876 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12877
12878no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12879 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12880 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12881 default value.
12882 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12883 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12884
12885no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12886 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12887 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12888 default value.
12889 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12890 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12891
12892no-ssl
12893 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12894 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12895 default value.
12896 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12897 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12898
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012899no-ssl-reuse
12900 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12901 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12902 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12903 and for paranoid users.
12904
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012905no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012906 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12907 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012908 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012909
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012910 Supported in default-server: No
12911
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012912no-tls-tickets
12913 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12914 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12915 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012916 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12917 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012918 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12919 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12920 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012921 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012922
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012923no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012924 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012925 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12926 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012927 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12928 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012929 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012930
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012931 Supported in default-server: No
12932
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012933no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012934 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012935 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12936 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012937 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12938 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012939 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012940
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012941 Supported in default-server: No
12942
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012943no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012944 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012945 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12946 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012947 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12948 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012949 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012950
12951 Supported in default-server: No
12952
12953no-tlsv13
12954 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12955 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12956 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12957 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12958 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012959 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012960
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012961 Supported in default-server: No
12962
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012963no-verifyhost
12964 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12965 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12966 default value.
12967 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12968 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012969
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012970no-tfo
12971 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12972 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12973 default value.
12974 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12975 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12976
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012977non-stick
12978 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12979 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12980 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12981
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012982npn <protocols>
12983 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12984 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12985 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012986 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012987 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12988 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12989 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12990
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012991observe <mode>
12992 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12993 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12994 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12995 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12996 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12997 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012998 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012999
13000 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13001
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013002on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013003 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13004 Currently, four modes are available:
13005 - fastinter: force fastinter
13006 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13007 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13008 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13009 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13010
13011 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13012
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013013on-marked-down <action>
13014 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13015 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013016 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13017 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13018 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13019 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13020 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13021 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13022 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13023 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013024
13025 Actions are disabled by default
13026
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013027on-marked-up <action>
13028 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13029 Currently one action is available:
13030 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13031 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13032 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13033 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013034 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13035 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013036 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13037 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13038
13039 Actions are disabled by default
13040
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013041pool-max-conn <max>
13042 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13043 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13044 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13045 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13046 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13047 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13048
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013049pool-purge-delay <delay>
13050 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013051 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013052 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013053
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013054port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013055 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13056 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13057 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13058 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13059 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13060 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13061
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013062proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013063 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13064 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
13065 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
13066 reported in haproxy -vv.
13067 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
13068 protocol for all connections established to this server.
13069
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013070redir <prefix>
13071 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
13072 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
13073 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
13074 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
13075 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
13076 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
13077 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
13078 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013079 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013080 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013081 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
13082 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
13083 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
13084 loop between the client and HAProxy!
13085
13086 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
13087
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013088rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013089 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
13090 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
13091 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
13092
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013093resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
13094 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
13095 server.
13096
13097 Available options:
13098
13099 * allow-dup-ip
13100 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
13101 resolution at runtime is in operation.
13102 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
13103 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
13104 For such case, simply enable this option.
13105 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
13106
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050013107 * ignore-weight
13108 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
13109 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
13110 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
13111
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013112 * prevent-dup-ip
13113 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
13114 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
13115 same fqdn.
13116 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
13117
13118 Example:
13119 backend b_myapp
13120 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
13121 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13122 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13123
13124 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
13125 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
13126 it
13127 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
13128 different address
13129
13130 Default value: not set
13131
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013132resolve-prefer <family>
13133 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
13134 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
13135 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
13136 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
13137
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020013138 Default value: ipv6
13139
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013140 Example:
13141
13142 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013143
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013144resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013145 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013146 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013147 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013148 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
13149 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013150 configured network, another address is selected.
13151
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013152 Example:
13153
13154 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013155
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013156resolvers <id>
13157 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
13158 hostname.
13159
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013160 Example:
13161
13162 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013163
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013164 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013165
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013166send-proxy
13167 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
13168 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
13169 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
13170 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013171 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
13172 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
13173 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
13174 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
13175 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
13176 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
13177 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
13178 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
13179 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
13180 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013181 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
13182 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013183
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013184send-proxy-v2
13185 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
13186 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13187 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13188 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020013189 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
13190 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
13191 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
13192 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013193
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013194proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010013195 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
13196 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
13197
13198 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
13199 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
13200 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
13201 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
13202 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
13203 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
13204 connection is supported).
13205 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
13206 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
13207 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
13208 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
13209 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
13210 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
13211 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013212
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013213send-proxy-v2-ssl
13214 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13215 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13216 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13217 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13218 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13219 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
13220 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013221 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
13222 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013223
13224send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13225 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13226 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13227 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13228 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13229 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13230 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
13231 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
13232 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013233 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
13234 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013235
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013236slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013237 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
13238 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
13239 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
13240 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
13241 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
13242 parameters :
13243
13244 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
13245 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
13246
13247 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
13248 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
13249 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
13250 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
13251
13252 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
13253 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
13254 seen as failed.
13255
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013256sni <expression>
13257 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
13258 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
13259 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
13260 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020013261 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
13262 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013263 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010013264 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
13265 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013266
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013267source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020013268source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013269source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013270 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
13271 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
13272 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
13273 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
13274
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013275 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
13276 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
13277 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
13278 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
13279 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
13280 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
13281 server.
13282
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000013283 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
13284 specifying the source address without port(s).
13285
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013286ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020013287 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
13288 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
13289 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
13290 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
13291 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
13292 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013293 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
13294 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013295
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013296ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13297 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
13298 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13299 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13300
13301ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13302 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
13303 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13304 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
13305
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013306ssl-reuse
13307 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
13308 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13309 default value.
13310 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13311 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
13312
13313stick
13314 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
13315 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13316 default value.
13317 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13318 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013319
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013320socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013321 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013322 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
13323 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
13324
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013325tcp-ut <delay>
13326 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
13327 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
13328 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013329 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013330 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
13331 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
13332 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
13333 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
13334 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
13335 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
13336 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
13337 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
13338 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13339
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013340tfo
13341 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
13342 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
13343 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
13344 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
13345 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013346 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013347
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013348track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020013349 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
13350 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
13351 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
13352 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013353 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
13354
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013355tls-tickets
13356 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
13357 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13358 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013359 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13360 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13361 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013362 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010013363 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013364
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013365verify [none|required]
13366 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010013367 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013368 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
13369 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013370 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013371 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
13372 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
13373 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
13374 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
13375 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
13376 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
13377 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
13378 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013379
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013380verifyhost <hostname>
13381 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013382 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
13383 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
13384 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
13385 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
13386 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
13387 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
13388 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
13389 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013390
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013391weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013392 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
13393 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
13394 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020013395 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
13396 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
13397 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
13398 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
13399 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
13400 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013401
13402
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200134035.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
13404-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013405
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013406HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
13407using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
13408configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013409This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
13410can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
13411workload.
13412This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
13413resolution at run time.
13414Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
13415carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
13416
13417
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200134185.3.1. Global overview
13419----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013420
13421As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
13422different steps of the process life:
13423
13424 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
13425 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
13426 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
13427
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013428 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
13429 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013430
13431A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
13432 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
13433 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
13434 resolution to know this new IP.
13435
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013436When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013437HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013438SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
13439from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
13440will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
13441will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020013442
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013443A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013444 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013445 first valid response.
13446
13447 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
13448 servers return an error.
13449
13450
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200134515.3.2. The resolvers section
13452----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013453
13454This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013455HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
13456contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013457
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013458When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
13459uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
13460is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
13461answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
13462
13463When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013464used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013465
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013466 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
13467 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
13468 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013469
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013470 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
13471 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013472
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013473 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
13474 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
13475 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013476
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013477For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
13478following scenarios are possible:
13479
13480 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13481 ignored
13482
13483 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13484 applied
13485
13486 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13487 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13488
13489 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13490 retries the query with a new type
13491
13492 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13493 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013494
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013495As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13496a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013497<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013498
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013499
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013500resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013501 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013502
13503A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13504
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013505accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013506 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013507 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013508 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13509 by RFC 6891)
13510
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013511 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13512
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013513nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13514 DNS server description:
13515 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13516 <ip> : IP address of the server
13517 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13518
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013519parse-resolv-conf
13520 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13521 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13522 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13523
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013524hold <status> <period>
13525 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13526 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013527 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013528 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013529 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13530 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13531 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13532
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013533 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013534
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013535resolve_retries <nb>
13536 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13537 giving up.
13538 Default value: 3
13539
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013540 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13541 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13542 type.
13543
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013544timeout <event> <time>
13545 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13546 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13547 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013548 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13549 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013550 Default value: 1s
13551 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013552 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013553 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013554 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13555 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13556
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013557 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013558
13559 resolvers mydns
13560 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13561 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013562 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013563 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013564 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013565 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013566 hold other 30s
13567 hold refused 30s
13568 hold nx 30s
13569 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013570 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013571 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013572
13573
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200135746. Cache
13575---------
13576
13577HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
13578(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
13579RAM.
13580
13581The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
13582this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
13583
13584If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
13585independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
13586when we try to allocate a new one.
13587
13588The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
13589
13590It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
13591"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
13592for more details.
13593
13594When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
13595replaced by "<CACHE>".
13596
13597
135986.1. Limitation
13599----------------
13600
13601The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
13602
13603- If the response is not a 200
13604- If the response contains a Vary header
13605- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
13606- If the response is not cacheable
13607
13608- If the request is not a GET
13609- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
13610- If the request contains an Authorization header
13611
13612
136136.2. Setup
13614-----------
13615
13616To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
13617the corresponding http-request and response actions.
13618
13619
136206.2.1. Cache section
13621---------------------
13622
13623cache <name>
13624 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
13625 size of cache is mandatory.
13626
13627total-max-size <megabytes>
13628 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
13629 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
13630
13631max-object-size <bytes>
13632 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
13633 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
13634 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
13635
13636max-age <seconds>
13637 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
13638 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
13639 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
13640 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
13641 default.
13642
13643
136446.2.2. Proxy section
13645---------------------
13646
13647http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13648 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
13649 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
13650 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
13651 after this one.
13652
13653http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13654 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
13655 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
13656 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
13657 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
13658
13659
13660Example:
13661
13662 backend bck1
13663 mode http
13664
13665 http-request cache-use foobar
13666 http-response cache-store foobar
13667 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
13668
13669 cache foobar
13670 total-max-size 4
13671 max-age 240
13672
13673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136747. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13675----------------------------------
13676
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013677HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013678client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13679The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13680these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13681but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13682data called patterns.
13683
13684
136857.1. ACL basics
13686---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013687
13688The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13689content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13690from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13691simple :
13692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013693 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013694 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013695 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13696 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013698The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13699adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013700
13701In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013703 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013704
13705This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13706Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13707and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013708an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13709conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13710as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13711are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013712
13713ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13714'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13715which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13716
13717There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13718performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013720The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13721specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13722this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013723methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13724ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013725
13726Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13727 - boolean
13728 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13729 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13730 - string
13731 - data block
13732
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013733Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13734converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13735would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13736The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13737which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13738
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013739Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13740keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13741fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13742which are summarized in the table below :
13743
13744 +---------------------+-----------------+
13745 | Sample or converter | Default |
13746 | output type | matching method |
13747 +---------------------+-----------------+
13748 | boolean | bool |
13749 +---------------------+-----------------+
13750 | integer | int |
13751 +---------------------+-----------------+
13752 | ip | ip |
13753 +---------------------+-----------------+
13754 | string | str |
13755 +---------------------+-----------------+
13756 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13757 +---------------------+-----------------+
13758
13759Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13760matching method, see below.
13761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013762The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13763 - boolean
13764 - integer or integer range
13765 - IP address / network
13766 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13767 - regular expression
13768 - hex block
13769
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013770The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13771
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013772 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13773 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013774 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013775 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013776 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013777 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013778 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013780The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13781read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13782if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13783lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13784will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13785beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13786a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13787lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13788exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13789
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013790The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13791parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13792ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13793a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13794check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13795
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013796The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13797socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13798file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013800Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13801loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13802
13803 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13804
13805In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13806the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13807case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13808as well.
13809
13810The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13811sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13812do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13813methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13814is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013815obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013816followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13817default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13818that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13819string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13820
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013821The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13822By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13823string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13824resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13825server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013826waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013827flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13828function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013830There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13831sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13832be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013833
13834 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13835 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013836 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13837 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13838 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13839 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013840
13841 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13842 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013843 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013844
13845 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013846 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013847
13848 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013849 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013850
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013851 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013852 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13853
13854 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13855 binary or string samples.
13856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013857 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13858 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013860 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13861 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13862 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013864 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13865 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013867 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13868 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013870 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13871 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013873 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13874 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013875 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013877 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13878 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13879 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013880
13881For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13882request, it is possible to do :
13883
13884 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13885
13886In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13887buffer, one would use the following acl :
13888
13889 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13890
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013891On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13892possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13893
13894 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013896All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13897criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13898method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13899to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13900criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13901the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013903If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013904the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13905For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013907 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13908 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13909 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13910 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013911
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013912
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013913The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13914types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13915combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13916brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13917default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013919 +-------------------------------------------------+
13920 | Input sample type |
13921 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013922 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013923 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13924 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13925 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013926 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013927 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013928 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013929 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013930 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013931 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013932 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013933 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013934 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013935 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013936 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013937 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013938 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013939 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013940 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013941 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013942 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013943 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013944 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013945 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013946 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013947 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13948 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13949 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013950
13951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200139527.1.1. Matching booleans
13953------------------------
13954
13955In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13956Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13957When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13958that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13959
13960Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13961return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13962"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13963
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200139657.1.2. Matching integers
13966------------------------
13967
13968Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13969enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13970to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13971
13972Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13973matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13974lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013975
13976For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13977unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13978representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13979
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013980As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13981two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13982instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13983ranges and operators.
13984
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013985For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013986operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13987Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13988of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013989
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013990Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013991
13992 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13993 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13994 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13995 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13996 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13997
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013998For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013999
14000 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14001
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014002This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14003
14004 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14005
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200140077.1.3. Matching strings
14008-----------------------
14009
14010String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14011different forms :
14012
14013 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014014 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014015
14016 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014017 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014018
14019 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14020 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14021
14022 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14023 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14024
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014025 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014026 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14027 matches.
14028
14029 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14030 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14031 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014032
14033String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14034exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14035characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14036string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14037to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014038before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014039
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014040Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14041(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14042Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14043
14044Example:
14045 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14046 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14047
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200140497.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14050---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014051
14052Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14053they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14054possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14055passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14056the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014057the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14058match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014059
14060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200140617.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
14062-------------------------------------
14063
14064It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
14065not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
14066a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
14067to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
14068digits may be used upper or lower case.
14069
14070Example :
14071 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
14072 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
14073
14074
140757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
14076---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014077
14078IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
14079netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
14080within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014081host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014082difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
14083at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
14084does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
14085parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014086
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020014087The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
14088abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
14089
14090 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14091 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
14092 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14093 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
14094 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
14095 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
14096 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
14097 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14098
14099Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
14100192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
14101
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014102IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
14103Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
14104trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
14105IPv6 patterns.
14106
14107HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
14108following situations :
14109 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
14110 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
14111 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
14112 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
14113 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
14114 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
14115 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
14116 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
14117 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
14118 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
14119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014120
141217.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
14122----------------------------------
14123
14124Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
14125combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
14126
14127 - AND (implicit)
14128 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
14129 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014131A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014133 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014135Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
14136indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014138For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
14139"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
14140requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
14141is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
14142
14143 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014144 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
14145 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
14146 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014147
14148To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
14149and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
14150
14151 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
14152 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
14153 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
14154 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
14155
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014156 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014157 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
14158 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
14159 use_backend www if host_www
14160
14161It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
14162expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
14163be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
14164the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
14165
14166 The following rule :
14167
14168 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014169 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014170
14171 Can also be written that way :
14172
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014173 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014174
14175It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
14176to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
14177simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
14178sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
14179good use is the following :
14180
14181 With named ACLs :
14182
14183 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
14184 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
14185 monitor fail if site_dead
14186
14187 With anonymous ACLs :
14188
14189 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
14190
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014191See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
14192keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014193
14194
141957.3. Fetching samples
14196---------------------
14197
14198Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
14199against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
14200sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
14201ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
14202of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
14203available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
14204
14205This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
14206Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
14207compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
14208deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
14209
14210The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
14211matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
14212method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
14213indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
14214
14215As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
14216when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
14217mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
14218the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
14219ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
14220
14221Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
14222multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
14223when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014224incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
14225are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014226is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
14227all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
14228
14229Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
14230 - name
14231 - name(arg1)
14232 - name(arg1,arg2)
14233
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014234
142357.3.1. Converters
14236-----------------
14237
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014238Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
14239of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
14240is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
14241was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014242has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014243unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
14244
14245These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
14246sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
14247the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014248support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014249
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014250A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
14251support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
14252supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
14253(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
14254bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
14255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014256The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014257
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001425851d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
14259 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14260 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14261 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
14262 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14263 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14264
14265 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014266 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
14267 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000014268 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
14269 frontend http-in
14270 bind *:8081
14271 default_backend servers
14272 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14273 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14274
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014275add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014276 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014277 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014278 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
14279 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014280 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014281 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14282 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14283 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14284 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014285 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014286 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014287
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010014288aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
14289 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
14290 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
14291 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
14292 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
14293 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
14294 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
14295
14296 Example:
14297 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
14298 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
14299
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014300and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014301 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014302 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014303 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14304 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014305 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014306 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14307 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14308 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14309 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014310 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014311 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014312
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020014313b64dec
14314 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
14315 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
14316
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014317base64
14318 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014319 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014320 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
14321
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014322bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014323 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014324 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014325 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014326 presence of a flag).
14327
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014328bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
14329 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
14330 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014331 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014332
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014333concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
14334 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
14335 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
14336 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
14337 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
14338 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
14339 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
14340 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
14341 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
14342 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
14343 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014344 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
14345 parethesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
14346 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
14347 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014348
14349 Example:
14350 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
14351 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
14352 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014353 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014354 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
14355
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014356cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014357 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
14358 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014359
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014360crc32([<avalanche>])
14361 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
14362 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14363 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14364 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14365 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14366 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
14367 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
14368 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
14369 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
14370 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014371 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
14372
14373crc32c([<avalanche>])
14374 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
14375 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14376 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14377 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
14378 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
14379 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
14380 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
14381 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014382
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020014383cut_crlf
14384 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
14385 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
14386 updated.
14387
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010014388da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014389 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
14390 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
14391 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
14392 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014393 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014394 configuration language.
14395
14396 Example:
14397 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014398 bind *:8881
14399 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014400 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014401
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010014402debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
14403 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
14404 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
14405 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
14406 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
14407 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
14408 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
14409 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
14410 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
14411 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
14412 printable sample types.
14413
14414 Example:
14415 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020014416
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014417div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014418 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14419 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014420 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014421 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
14422 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014423 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014424 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14425 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14426 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14427 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014428 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014429 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014430
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014431djb2([<avalanche>])
14432 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
14433 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14434 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14435 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14436 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14437 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14438 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014439 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
14440 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014441
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014442even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014443 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014444 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
14445
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014446field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14447 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
14448 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
14449 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
14450 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
14451 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
14452 fields.
14453
14454 Example :
14455 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
14456 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14457 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
14458 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
14459 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010014460
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014461hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014462 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014463 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014464 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014465 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010014466
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014467hex2i
14468 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014469 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014470
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020014471htonl
14472 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
14473 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
14474 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
14475 unsigned 32-bit integer.
14476
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014477http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014478 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14479 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014480 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
14481 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
14482 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
14483 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
14484 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
14485 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
14486 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
14487 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014488
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014489in_table(<table>)
14490 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14491 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14492 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014493 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014494 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14495
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014496ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14497 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014498 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014499 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14500 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14501 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14502 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14503 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014504
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014505json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014506 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014507 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014508 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014509 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14510 of errors:
14511 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14512 bytes, ...)
14513 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14514 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14515
14516 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14517 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14518 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14519 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14520 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14521 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014522 - "ascii" : never fails;
14523 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14524 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014525 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014526 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014527 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14528 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14529
14530 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014531 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014532
14533 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014534 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014535 capture request header user-agent len 150
14536 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014537
14538 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14539 GET / HTTP/1.0
14540 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14541
14542 Output log:
14543 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14544
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014545language(<value>[,<default>])
14546 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14547 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14548 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14549 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14550 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14551 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14552 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14553 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14554 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014555 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014556 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14557 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014558
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014559 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014560
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014561 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14562 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014563
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014564 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14565 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14566 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14567 use_backend spanish if es
14568 use_backend french if fr
14569 use_backend english if en
14570 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014571
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014572length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014573 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14574 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14575 type. The result is of type integer.
14576
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014577lower
14578 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14579 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14580 type. The result is of type string.
14581
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014582ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14583 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14584 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14585 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14586 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14587 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14588 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14589
14590 Example :
14591
14592 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014593 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014594 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14595
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020014596ltrim(<chars>)
14597 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
14598 representation of the input sample.
14599
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014600map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14601map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14602map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14603 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14604 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14605 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14606 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14607 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14608 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14609 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14610 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014611
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014612 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14613 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14614 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014615
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014616 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014617 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014618
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014619 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14620 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14621 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14622 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014623 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14624 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014625 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14626 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14627 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14628 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14629 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14630 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14631 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14632 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014633 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14634 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14635 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014636 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14637 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14638 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14639 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14640 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014641
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014642 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14643 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14644 the corresponding match text.
14645
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014646 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14647 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14648 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14649 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14650 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014651
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014652 Example :
14653
14654 # this is a comment and is ignored
14655 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14656 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14657 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14658 | | | `---------- value
14659 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14660 | `---------------------------- key
14661 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14662
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014663mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014664 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14665 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014666 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014667 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014668 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014669 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14670 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14671 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14672 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014673 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014674 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014675
14676mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014677 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020014678 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
14679 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014680 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014681 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014682 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014683 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14684 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14685 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14686 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014687 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014688 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014689
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010014690nbsrv
14691 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
14692 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
14693 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
14694 map lookup.
14695
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014696neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014697 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14698 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14699 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14700 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014701
14702not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014703 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014704 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014705 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014706 absence of a flag).
14707
14708odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014709 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014710 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14711
14712or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014713 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014714 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014715 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14716 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014717 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014718 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14719 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14720 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14721 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014722 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014723 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014724
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014725protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14726 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14727 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14728 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14729 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14730 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14731 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14732 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14733 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14734 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14735 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14736 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14737
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014738regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014739 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14740 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14741 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14742 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14743 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14744 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14745 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14746 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14747 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014748 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
14749 of characters with other ones.
14750
14751 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
14752 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
14753 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
14754 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
14755 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
14756 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014757
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014758 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014759
14760 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14761 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14762 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014763 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014764
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014765 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
14766 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
14767
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010014768 # capture groups and backreferences
14769 # both lines do the same.
14770 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)]'
14771 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
14772
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014773capture-req(<id>)
14774 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14775 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14776
14777 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014778 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14779 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014780
14781capture-res(<id>)
14782 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14783 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14784
14785 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014786 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14787 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014788
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020014789rtrim(<chars>)
14790 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
14791 of the input sample.
14792
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014793sdbm([<avalanche>])
14794 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14795 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14796 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14797 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14798 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14799 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14800 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014801 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14802 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014803
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014804set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014805 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14806 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14807 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014808 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014809 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14810 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014811 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014812 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14813 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014814 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014815 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014816
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014817sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014818 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014819 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14820
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014821sha2([<bits>])
14822 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
14823 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
14824
14825 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
14826 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
14827
14828 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14829 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14830
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020014831srv_queue
14832 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
14833 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
14834 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
14835 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
14836 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
14837
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014838strcmp(<var>)
14839 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14840 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14841 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14842 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14843 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14844 shorter).
14845
14846 Example :
14847
14848 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14849 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14850 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14851
14852
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014853sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014854 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14855 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014856 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014857 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14858 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014859 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014860 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14861 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014862 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014863 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14864 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014865 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014866 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014867
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014868table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14869 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14870 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14871 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14872 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14873 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14874 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14875
14876
14877table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14878 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14879 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14880 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14881 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14882 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14883 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14884
14885table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14886 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14887 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014888 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014889 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14890 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14891
14892table_conn_cur(<table>)
14893 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14894 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14895 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14896 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14897 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14898
14899table_conn_rate(<table>)
14900 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14901 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14902 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14903 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14904 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14905
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014906table_gpt0(<table>)
14907 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14908 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14909 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14910 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14911 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14912
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014913table_gpc0(<table>)
14914 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14915 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14916 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14917 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14918 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14919
14920table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14921 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14922 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14923 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14924 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14925 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14926 sample fetch keyword.
14927
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014928table_gpc1(<table>)
14929 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14930 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14931 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14932 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14933 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14934
14935table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14936 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14937 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14938 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14939 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14940 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14941 sample fetch keyword.
14942
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014943table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14944 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14945 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014946 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014947 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14948 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14949
14950table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14951 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14952 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14953 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14954 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14955 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14956 keyword.
14957
14958table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14959 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14960 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014961 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014962 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14963 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14964
14965table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14966 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14967 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14968 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14969 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14970 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14971 keyword.
14972
14973table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14974 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14975 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014976 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014977 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14978 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14979 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14980 keyword.
14981
14982table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14983 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14984 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014985 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014986 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14987 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14988 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14989 keyword.
14990
14991table_server_id(<table>)
14992 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14993 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14994 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14995 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14996 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14997 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14998
14999table_sess_cnt(<table>)
15000 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15001 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015002 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015003 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
15004 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15005 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
15006 keyword.
15007
15008table_sess_rate(<table>)
15009 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15010 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15011 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
15012 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
15013 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15014 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
15015 keyword.
15016
15017table_trackers(<table>)
15018 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15019 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15020 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15021 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
15022 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
15023 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
15024 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
15025 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
15026 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
15027 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
15028
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015029upper
15030 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
15031 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15032 type. The result is of type string.
15033
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020015034url_dec([<in_form>])
15035 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
15036 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
15037 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
15038 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
15039 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
15040 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020015041
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015042ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015043 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015044 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
15045 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
15046 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015047 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15048 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15049 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15050 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015051 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015052 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15053 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015054
15055 Example:
15056 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
15057 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
15058
15059 message Point {
15060 int32 latitude = 1;
15061 int32 longitude = 2;
15062 }
15063
15064 message PPoint {
15065 Point point = 59;
15066 }
15067
15068 message Rectangle {
15069 // One corner of the rectangle.
15070 PPoint lo = 48;
15071 // The other corner of the rectangle.
15072 PPoint hi = 49;
15073 }
15074
15075 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
15076 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
15077 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
15078
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015079 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15080 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015081 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015082 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
15083
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015084 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015085
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015086 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015087
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015088 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015089 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15090 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
15091
15092 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
15093 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
15094 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
15095
15096 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
15097 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
15098 interpret the previous binary sample.
15099
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015100
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010015101unset-var(<var name>)
15102 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
15103 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
15104 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
15105 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15106 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
15107 response),
15108 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15109 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
15110 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
15111 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
15112
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015113utime(<format>[,<offset>])
15114 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15115 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
15116 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15117 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15118 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15119 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
15120
15121 Example :
15122
15123 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015124 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015125 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15126
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015127word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15128 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
15129 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
15130 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015131 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015132 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
15133 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
15134
15135 Example :
15136 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
15137 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15138 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
15139 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
15140 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015141 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010015142
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015143wt6([<avalanche>])
15144 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
15145 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15146 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15147 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15148 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15149 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15150 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015151 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
15152 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015153
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015154xor(<value>)
15155 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015156 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015157 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015158 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015159 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015160 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15161 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015162 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015163 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15164 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015165 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015166 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015167
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010015168xxh32([<seed>])
15169 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
15170 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15171 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15172 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15173 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15174 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15175 as cryptographically secure.
15176
15177xxh64([<seed>])
15178 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
15179 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15180 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15181 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15182 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15183 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15184 as cryptographically secure.
15185
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015186
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200151877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015188--------------------------------------------
15189
15190A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
15191not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
15192"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
15193The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
15194
15195always_false : boolean
15196 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15197 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15198
15199always_true : boolean
15200 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15201 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15202
15203avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015204 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015205 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
15206 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
15207 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
15208 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
15209 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
15210 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
15211 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
15212 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
15213 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
15214 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
15215 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
15216 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
15217 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010015218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015219be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015220 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
15221 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
15222 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
15223 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015224 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
15225
15226be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
15227 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15228 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
15229 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
15230 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
15231 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015232 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
15233 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015234
15235 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
15236 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
15237 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015239be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
15240 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15241 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15242 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015243 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015244 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
15245 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015246
15247 Example :
15248 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
15249 backend dynamic
15250 mode http
15251 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
15252 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015253
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015254bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015255 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
15256 of the string.
15257
15258bool(<bool>) : bool
15259 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
15260 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
15261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015262connslots([<backend>]) : integer
15263 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015264 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015265 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
15266 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050015267
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015268 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015269 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015270 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
15271
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015272 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
15273 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015274
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015275 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015276 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015277 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015278 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015279 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015280 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015281 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015282
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015283 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
15284 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015285 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015286 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015287
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015288cpu_calls : integer
15289 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
15290 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
15291 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
15292 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
15293 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
15294 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
15295
15296cpu_ns_avg : integer
15297 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15298 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15299 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15300 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15301 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15302 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15303 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
15304 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
15305 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
15306 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
15307 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15308
15309cpu_ns_tot : integer
15310 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15311 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15312 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15313 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15314 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15315 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15316 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
15317 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
15318 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
15319 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
15320 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
15321 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
15322 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
15323
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015324date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015325 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015326
15327 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
15328 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
15329 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015330 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
15331
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015332 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
15333 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
15334 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
15335 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
15336 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
15337
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015338 Example :
15339
15340 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
15341 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015342
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015343 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
15344 # millisecond granularity
15345 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
15346
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010015347date_us : integer
15348 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
15349 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
15350 from the same timeval structure.
15351
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020015352distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
15353 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
15354 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
15355 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
15356 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
15357 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
15358 list of supported tokens.
15359
15360distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
15361 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
15362 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
15363 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
15364 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
15365 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
15366 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
15367 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
15368 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
15369 supported tokens.
15370
15371 Example :
15372 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
15373 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
15374 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
15375 # send large files to the big farm
15376 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
15377
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020015378env(<name>) : string
15379 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
15380 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
15381 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
15382 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
15383 certain way.
15384
15385 Examples :
15386 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
15387 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
15388
15389 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
15390 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
15391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015392fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
15393 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015394 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
15395 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015396 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
15397 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015398 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015399 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
15400 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015401
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020015402fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15403 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
15404 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
15405 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
15406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015407fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15408 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15409 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15410 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
15411 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
15412 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
15413 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
15414 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
15415 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015416
15417 Example :
15418 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
15419 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
15420 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
15421 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
15422 frontend mail
15423 bind :25
15424 mode tcp
15425 maxconn 100
15426 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
15427 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
15428 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
15429 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015430
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010015431hostname : string
15432 Returns the system hostname.
15433
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015434int(<integer>) : signed integer
15435 Returns a signed integer.
15436
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015437ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
15438 Returns an ipv4.
15439
15440ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
15441 Returns an ipv6.
15442
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015443lat_ns_avg : integer
15444 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15445 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15446 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15447 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15448 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15449 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15450 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15451 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15452 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15453 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15454 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15455 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15456 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
15457 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15458
15459lat_ns_tot : integer
15460 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15461 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15462 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15463 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15464 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15465 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15466 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15467 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15468 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15469 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15470 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15471 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15472 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
15473 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
15474 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
15475 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
15476 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
15477 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
15478 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
15479
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015480meth(<method>) : method
15481 Returns a method.
15482
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015483nbproc : integer
15484 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
15485 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
15486 and debugging purposes.
15487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015488nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
15489 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
15490 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
15491 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015492 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
15493 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
15494 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015495
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040015496prio_class : integer
15497 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
15498 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
15499 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
15500
15501prio_offset : integer
15502 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
15503 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
15504 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
15505 set-priority-offset".
15506
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015507proc : integer
15508 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
15509 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
15510 debugging purposes.
15511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015512queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015513 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
15514 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
15515 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015516 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
15517 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
15518 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15519 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15520 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15521
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015522rand([<range>]) : integer
15523 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15524 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15525 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15526 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15527 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15528
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015529uuid([<version>]) : string
15530 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15531 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15532 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015534srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15535 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15536 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15537 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
15538 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
15539 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015540 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
15541 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
15542
15543srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15544 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15545 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
15546 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15547 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
15548 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
15549 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
15550 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
15551
15552 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
15553 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015554
15555srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
15556 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
15557 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
15558 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015559 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015560 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
15561 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15562 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15563
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015564srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15565 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15566 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15567 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15568 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15569 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15570 fetch methods.
15571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015572srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15573 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15574 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015575 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015576 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15577 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015578 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015579 overloading servers).
15580
15581 Example :
15582 # Redirect to a separate back
15583 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15584 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15585 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15586
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015587stopping : boolean
15588 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15589 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15590 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15591
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015592str(<string>) : string
15593 Returns a string.
15594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015595table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15596 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15597 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15598
15599table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15600 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15601 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15602 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15603
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015604thread : integer
15605 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15606 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15607 and debugging purposes.
15608
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015609var(<var-name>) : undefined
15610 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015611 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15612 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015613 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015614 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15615 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015616 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015617 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15618 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015619 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015620 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015621
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200156227.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015623----------------------------------
15624
15625The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15626closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15627methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15628sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15629TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015630the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15631counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020015632"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
15633used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
15634can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
15635Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
15636table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
15637tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15638currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015639
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015640bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015641 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15642 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15643 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015645be_id : integer
15646 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
15647 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15648
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015649be_name : string
15650 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
15651 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015653dst : ip
15654 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15655 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15656 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15657 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015658 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15659 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15660 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15661 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15662 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15663 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015664
15665dst_conn : integer
15666 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15667 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15668 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15669 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15670 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15671 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15672 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15673 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015674
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015675dst_is_local : boolean
15676 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
15677 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
15678 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
15679 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015680 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015681 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
15682 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
15683 it only once per connection.
15684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015685dst_port : integer
15686 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
15687 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
15688 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
15689 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
15690 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
15691 an HTTP header.
15692
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020015693fc_http_major : integer
15694 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15695 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15696 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
15697
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020015698fc_pp_authority : string
15699 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15700 if any.
15701
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010015702fc_pp_unique_id : string
15703 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15704 if any.
15705
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010015706fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
15707 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
15708 header.
15709
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020015710fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
15711 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
15712 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
15713 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
15714 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15715 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15716 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15717
15718fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
15719 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
15720 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
15721 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
15722 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15723 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15724 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15725
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015726fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015727 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15728 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15729 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15730 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15731
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015732fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015733 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15734 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15735 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15736 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15737
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015738fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015739 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
15740 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15741 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15742 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15743
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015744fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015745 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
15746 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15747 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15748 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15749
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015750fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015751 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
15752 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15753 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15754 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15755
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015756fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015757 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15758 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15759 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15760 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15761
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015762fe_defbe : string
15763 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15764 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015766fe_id : integer
15767 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015768 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015769 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15770
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015771fe_name : string
15772 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15773 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15774 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15775
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015776sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015777sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15778sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15779sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015780 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15781 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15782 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15783
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015784sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015785sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15786sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15787sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015788 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15789 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15790 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15791
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015792sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015793sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15794sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15795sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015796 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15797 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015798 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15799 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15800 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015801
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015802 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015803 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15804 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015805 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15806 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15807 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015808 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15809 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15810
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015811sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15812sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15813sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15814sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15815 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15816 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15817 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15818 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15819 when a first ACL was verified.
15820
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015821sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015822sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15823sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15824sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015825 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015826 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15827
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015828sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015829sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15830sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15831sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015832 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15833 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15834 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15835
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015836sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015837sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15838sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15839sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015840 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15841 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15842 See also src_conn_rate.
15843
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015844sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015845sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15846sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15847sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015848 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015849 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015850
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015851sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15852sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15853sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15854sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15855 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15856 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15857
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015858sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15859sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15860sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15861sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15862 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15863 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15864
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015865sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015866sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15867sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15868sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015869 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15870 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15871 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015872 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15873 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15874 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015875
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015876sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15877sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15878sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15879sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15880 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15881 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15882 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15883 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15884 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15885 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15886
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015887sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015888sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15889sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15890sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015891 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015892 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15893 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15894
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015895sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015896sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15897sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15898sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015899 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15900 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15901 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15902 src_http_err_rate.
15903
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015904sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015905sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15906sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15907sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015908 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015909 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15910 src_http_req_cnt.
15911
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015912sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015913sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15914sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15915sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015916 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15917 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15918 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15919 src_http_req_rate.
15920
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015921sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015922sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15923sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15924sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015925 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015926 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15927 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15928 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15929 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015930
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015931 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015932 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15933 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015934 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15935
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015936sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15937sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15938sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15939sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15940 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15941 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15942 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15943 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15944 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15945
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015946sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015947sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15948sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15949sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015950 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15951 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15952 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015953
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015954sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015955sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15956sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15957sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015958 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15959 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15960 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015961
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015962sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015963sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15964sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15965sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015966 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015967 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15968 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15969 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015970 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015971 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15972
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015973sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015974sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15975sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15976sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015977 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15978 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15979 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15980 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15981 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015982 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015983
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015984sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015985sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15986sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15987sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015988 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15989 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15990 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15991
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015992sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015993sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15994sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15995sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015996 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15997 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015998 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015999 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
16000 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016001 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
16002 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
16003 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016005so_id : integer
16006 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
16007 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
16008 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016009
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010016010so_name : string
16011 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
16012 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
16013 strings instead of integers.
16014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016015src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016016 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016017 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
16018 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
16019 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016020 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
16021 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
16022 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016023 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
16024 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
16025 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
16026 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
16027 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
16028 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
16029 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016030
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016031 Example:
16032 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
16033 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
16034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016035src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16036 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
16037 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
16038 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016039 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016041src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16042 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
16043 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016044 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016045 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016047src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16048 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16049 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16050 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16051 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16052 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16053 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016054
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016055 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016056 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16057 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
16058 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
16059 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016060 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016061 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16062 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16063
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016064src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16065 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16066 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16067 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16068 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16069 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16070 was verified.
16071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016072src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016073 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016074 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016075 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016076 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016078src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016079 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016080 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16081 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016082 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016084src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16085 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
16086 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16087 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016088 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016090src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016091 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016092 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016093 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016094 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016095
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016096src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16097 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16098 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16099 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16100 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
16101
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016102src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16103 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16104 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16105 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16106 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
16107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016108src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016109 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016110 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016111 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16112 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016113 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16114 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16115 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016116
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016117src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16118 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16119 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16120 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16121 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16122 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16123 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16124 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016126src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016127 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016128 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016129 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016130 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016131 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016133src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16134 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
16135 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16136 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16137 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016138 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016140src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016141 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016142 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16143 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016144 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016146src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16147 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
16148 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16149 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016150 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016151 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016153src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16154 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16155 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16156 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016157 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016158 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16159 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016160
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016161 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016162 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016163 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016164 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016165
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016166src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16167 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16168 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16169 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
16170 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16171 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16172 connection when a first ACL was verified.
16173
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016174src_is_local : boolean
16175 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
16176 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
16177 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
16178 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016179 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016180 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
16181 once per connection.
16182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016183src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016184 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
16185 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
16186 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
16187 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
16188 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016190src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016191 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
16192 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16193 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
16194 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
16195 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016197src_port : integer
16198 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
16199 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
16200 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
16201 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016203src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016204 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016205 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16206 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
16207 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016208 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016210src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16211 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
16212 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16213 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16214 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016215 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016217src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16218 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
16219 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
16220 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
16221 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
16222 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
16223 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
16224 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
16225 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016226
16227 Example :
16228 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
16229 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
16230 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
16231 listen ssh
16232 bind :22
16233 mode tcp
16234 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016235 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016236 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016237 server local 127.0.0.1:22
16238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016239srv_id : integer
16240 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
16241 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
16242 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020016243
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016244srv_name : string
16245 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
16246 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
16247 debugging.
16248
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200162497.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016250----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020016251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016252The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
16253closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
16254when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
16255usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016256future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016257
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001625851d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
16259 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16260 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16261 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
16262 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16263 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16264
16265 Example :
16266 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
16267 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
16268 # the request.
16269 frontend http-in
16270 bind *:8081
16271 default_backend servers
16272 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16273 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16274
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016275ssl_bc : boolean
16276 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16277 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
16278 other a server with the "ssl" option.
16279
16280ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
16281 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
16282 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16283
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016284ssl_bc_alpn : string
16285 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
16286 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016287 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016288 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16289 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16290 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
16291 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
16292 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16293 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
16294
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016295ssl_bc_cipher : string
16296 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
16297 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16298
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016299ssl_bc_client_random : binary
16300 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16301 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16302 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16303
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016304ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
16305 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16306 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
16307 session or a TLS ticket.
16308
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016309ssl_bc_npn : string
16310 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
16311 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016312 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016313 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
16314 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
16315 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
16316 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
16317 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
16318
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016319ssl_bc_protocol : string
16320 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
16321 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16322
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016323ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016324 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016325 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16326 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016327
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016328ssl_bc_server_random : binary
16329 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16330 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16331 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16332
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016333ssl_bc_session_id : binary
16334 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
16335 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
16336 if session was reused or not.
16337
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016338ssl_bc_session_key : binary
16339 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
16340 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16341 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16342 BoringSSL.
16343
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016344ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
16345 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
16346 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016348ssl_c_ca_err : integer
16349 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16350 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
16351 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
16352 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
16353 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016355ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
16356 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16357 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
16358 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
16359 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016360
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016361ssl_c_der : binary
16362 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
16363 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16364 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016366ssl_c_err : integer
16367 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16368 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
16369 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
16370 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
16371 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016372
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016373ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016374 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16375 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16376 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16377 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16378 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16379 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16380 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16381 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016382 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16383 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16384 LDAP v3.
16385 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16386 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016388ssl_c_key_alg : string
16389 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16390 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16391 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016393ssl_c_notafter : string
16394 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
16395 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16396 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016398ssl_c_notbefore : string
16399 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
16400 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16401 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016402
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016403ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016404 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16405 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16406 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16407 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16408 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16409 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16410 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16411 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016412 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16413 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16414 LDAP v3.
16415 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16416 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016418ssl_c_serial : binary
16419 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
16420 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16421 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016423ssl_c_sha1 : binary
16424 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
16425 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
16426 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016427 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
16428 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
16429
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016430 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016431 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016433ssl_c_sig_alg : string
16434 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16435 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16436 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016438ssl_c_used : boolean
16439 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
16440 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016442ssl_c_verify : integer
16443 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
16444 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
16445 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
16446 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016448ssl_c_version : integer
16449 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
16450 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016451
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016452ssl_f_der : binary
16453 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
16454 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16455 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16456
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016457ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016458 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16459 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16460 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16461 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016462 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016463 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16464 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16465 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016466 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16467 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16468 LDAP v3.
16469 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16470 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016472ssl_f_key_alg : string
16473 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16474 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
16475 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016477ssl_f_notafter : string
16478 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16479 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16480 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016482ssl_f_notbefore : string
16483 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16484 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16485 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016486
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016487ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016488 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16489 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16490 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16491 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16492 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16493 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16494 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16495 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016496 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16497 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16498 LDAP v3.
16499 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16500 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016502ssl_f_serial : binary
16503 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16504 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16505 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016506
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020016507ssl_f_sha1 : binary
16508 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
16509 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
16510 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
16511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016512ssl_f_sig_alg : string
16513 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16514 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16515 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016517ssl_f_version : integer
16518 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16519 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16520
16521ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016522 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16523 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
16524 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
16525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016526 Example :
16527 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
16528 listen http-https
16529 bind :80
16530 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
16531 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
16532
16533ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
16534 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
16535 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16536
16537ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016538 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016539 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
16540 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
16541 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16542 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16543 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
16544 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
16545 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16546 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
16547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016548ssl_fc_cipher : string
16549 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
16550 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020016551
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016552ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
16553 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
16554 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016555 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016556
16557ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
16558 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
16559 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016560 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016561
16562ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
16563 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
16564 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
16565 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016566 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020016567 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016568
16569ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
16570 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
16571 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016572 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016573
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016574ssl_fc_client_random : binary
16575 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16576 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16577 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016579ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016580 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
16581 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010016582 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
16583 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
16584 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
16585 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016586
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020016587ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
16588 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
16589 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
16590 wait until the handshake happened.
16591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016592ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
16593 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016594 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
16595 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016596 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016597 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016598
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020016599ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016600 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010016601 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
16602 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016604ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016605 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016606 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
16607 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
16608 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
16609 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
16610 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
16611 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
16612 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020016613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016614ssl_fc_protocol : string
16615 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
16616 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016617
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016618ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016619 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016620 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16621 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016622
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016623ssl_fc_server_random : binary
16624 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16625 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16626 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016628ssl_fc_session_id : binary
16629 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
16630 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
16631 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
16632 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016633
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016634ssl_fc_session_key : binary
16635 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
16636 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16637 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16638 BoringSSL.
16639
16640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016641ssl_fc_sni : string
16642 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
16643 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
16644 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
16645 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
16646 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16647
16648 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16649 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16650 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016651 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016652 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016654 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016655 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16656 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016658ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16659 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16660 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016661
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016662
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200166637.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016664------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016666Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
16667sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
16668only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
16669For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
16670be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
16671can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
16672sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
16673for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
16674content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016676payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016677 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016678 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
16679 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016681payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
16682 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016683 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016684 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016685
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020016686req.hdrs : string
16687 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
16688 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
16689 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
16690 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
16691
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020016692req.hdrs_bin : binary
16693 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
16694 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
16695 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
16696 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
16697 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
16698 names and values (length of 0 for both).
16699
16700 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
16701
16702 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
16703 str: <int:length><bytes>
16704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016705req.len : integer
16706req_len : integer (deprecated)
16707 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16708 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16709 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16710 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16711 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16712 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16713 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
16714 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016716req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16717 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016718 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16719 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16720 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16721 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016723 ACL alternatives :
16724 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016726req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16727 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16728 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16729 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
16730 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016732 ACL alternatives :
16733 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016735 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016737req.proto_http : boolean
16738req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
16739 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
16740 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
16741 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
16742 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
16743 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
16744 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
16745 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016747 Example:
16748 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
16749 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16750 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016751 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016753req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
16754rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16755 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
16756 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
16757 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
16758 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
16759 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
16760 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
16761 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016763 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
16764 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
16765 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
16766 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
16767 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
16768 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016770 ACL derivatives :
16771 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016773 Example :
16774 listen tse-farm
16775 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
16776 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
16777 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16778 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16779 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16780 persist rdp-cookie
16781 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16782 # This is only useful makes sense if
16783 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16784 stick-table type string size 204800
16785 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16786 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16787 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016789 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16790 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016792req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16793rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16794 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16795 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16796 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16797 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016799 ACL derivatives :
16800 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016801
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016802req.ssl_alpn : string
16803 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16804 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16805 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16806 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16807 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16808 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016809 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016810
16811 Examples :
16812 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16813 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16814 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016815 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016816 default_backend bk_default
16817
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016818req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16819 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16820 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016821 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16822 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16823 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16824 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16825 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016827req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16828req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16829 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16830 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16831 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16832 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16833 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16834 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16835 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016837req.ssl_sni : string
16838req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16839 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16840 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16841 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16842 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16843 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16844 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16845 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16846 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16847 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16848 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16849 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16850 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016852 ACL derivatives :
16853 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016855 Examples :
16856 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16857 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16858 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16859 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16860 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016861
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016862req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16863 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16864 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16865 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16866 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16867 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16868 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16869 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16870 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16871 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016873req.ssl_ver : integer
16874req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16875 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16876 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16877 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16878 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16879 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16880 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16881 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016882 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016883 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016885 ACL derivatives :
16886 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016887
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016888res.len : integer
16889 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16890 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16891 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16892 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16893 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16894 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16895 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16896 content inspection.
16897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016898res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16899 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016900 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16901 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16902 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16903 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016905res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16906 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16907 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16908 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16909 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016911 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016912
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016913res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16914rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16915 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16916 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16917 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16918 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16919 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16920 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16921 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016923wait_end : boolean
16924 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16925 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016926 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016927 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16928 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016929 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016930 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16931 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016933 Examples :
16934 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16935 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16936 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016938 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16939 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16940 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16941 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16942 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16943 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16944 tcp-request content reject
16945
16946
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200169477.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016948--------------------------------------
16949
16950It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16951This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16952data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16953its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16954HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16955content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16956to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16957more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16958response are indexed.
16959
16960base : string
16961 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16962 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16963 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16964 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16965 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16966 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16967 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16968 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16969
16970 ACL derivatives :
16971 base : exact string match
16972 base_beg : prefix match
16973 base_dir : subdir match
16974 base_dom : domain match
16975 base_end : suffix match
16976 base_len : length match
16977 base_reg : regex match
16978 base_sub : substring match
16979
16980base32 : integer
16981 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16982 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16983 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016984 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16985 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16986 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016987
16988base32+src : binary
16989 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16990 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16991 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16992 per-URL counters.
16993
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016994capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16995 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16996 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16997 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16998
16999capture.req.method : string
17000 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
17001 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
17002 because it's allocated.
17003
17004capture.req.uri : string
17005 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
17006 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
17007 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
17008 allocated.
17009
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017010capture.req.ver : string
17011 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17012 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
17013 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
17014
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017015capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
17016 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
17017 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17018 The first entry is an index of 0.
17019 See also: "capture response header"
17020
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017021capture.res.ver : string
17022 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17023 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
17024 persistent flag.
17025
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017026req.body : binary
17027 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
17028 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
17029 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
17030 the first chunk is analyzed.
17031
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020017032req.body_param([<name>) : string
17033 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
17034 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
17035 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
17036 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
17037 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
17038 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
17039 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
17040 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
17041 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
17042 given.
17043
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017044req.body_len : integer
17045 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
17046 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
17047 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
17048 "option http-buffer-request".
17049
17050req.body_size : integer
17051 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
17052 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
17053 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
17054 that the request body has been buffered made available using
17055 "option http-buffer-request".
17056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017057req.cook([<name>]) : string
17058cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17059 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17060 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
17061 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
17062 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
17063 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
17064 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
17065 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
17066 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
17067
17068 ACL derivatives :
17069 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
17070 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
17071 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
17072 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
17073 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
17074 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
17075 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
17076 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017078req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17079cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17080 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17081 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017083req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17084cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17085 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17086 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
17087 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
17088 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017090cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17091 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17092 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
17093 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
17094 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017095 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017096 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
17097 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
17098 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
17099 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017101hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17102 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
17103 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
17104 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
17105 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017106 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017108req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
17109 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17110 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17111 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17112 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17113 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17114 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
17115 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
17116 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017118req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17119 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17120 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17121 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17122 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017124req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17125 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17126 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17127 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17128 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17129 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17130 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
17131 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
17132 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000017133 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017134 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017135 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017137 ACL derivatives :
17138 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17139 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17140 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17141 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17142 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17143 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17144 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17145 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17146
17147req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17148hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
17149 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17150 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
17151 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
17152 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
17153 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
17154 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
17155 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
17156 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
17157 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
17158
17159req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17160hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17161 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
17162 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
17163 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
17164 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17165 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017166 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017167 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
17168 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
17169
17170req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17171hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17172 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
17173 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
17174 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
17175 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17176 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17177 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17178 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
17179
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010017180
17181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017182http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
17183 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
17184 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
17185 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17186 basic auth is supported.
17187
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017188http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
17189 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
17190 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
17191 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
17192 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017193 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17194 basic auth is supported.
17195
17196 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017197 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
17198 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
17199 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
17200 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017201
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017202http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017203 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
17204 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17205 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017206
17207http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017208 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
17209 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17210 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017211
17212http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017213 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
17214 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
17215 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017217http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017218 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
17219 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017220 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
17221 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017223method : integer + string
17224 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
17225 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
17226 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
17227 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
17228 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
17229 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
17230 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017232 ACL derivatives :
17233 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017235 Example :
17236 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
17237 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
17238 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017240path : string
17241 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
17242 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
17243 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
17244 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
17245 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017246 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017247 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017249 ACL derivatives :
17250 path : exact string match
17251 path_beg : prefix match
17252 path_dir : subdir match
17253 path_dom : domain match
17254 path_end : suffix match
17255 path_len : length match
17256 path_reg : regex match
17257 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017258
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017259query : string
17260 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
17261 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
17262 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
17263 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017264 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017265 which stops before the question mark.
17266
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017267req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17268 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17269 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17270 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
17271 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
17272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017273req.ver : string
17274req_ver : string (deprecated)
17275 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
17276 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
17277 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017279 ACL derivatives :
17280 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017282res.comp : boolean
17283 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
17284 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
17285 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017287res.comp_algo : string
17288 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
17289 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
17290 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017292res.cook([<name>]) : string
17293scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17294 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17295 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
17296 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017298 ACL derivatives :
17299 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017301res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17302scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17303 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17304 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
17305 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017307res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17308scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17309 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17310 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
17311 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017313res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17314 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17315 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17316 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17317 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17318 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
17319 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
17320 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
17321 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
17322 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017324res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17325 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17326 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17327 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17328 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
17329 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017331res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17332shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
17333 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17334 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17335 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17336 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17337 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
17338 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
17339 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
17340 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017342 ACL derivatives :
17343 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17344 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17345 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17346 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17347 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17348 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17349 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17350 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17351
17352res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17353shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17354 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17355 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17356 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
17357 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
17358 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017360res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17361shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17362 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
17363 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
17364 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
17365 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
17366 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
17367 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017368
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017369res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17370 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17371 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17372 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
17373 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
17374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017375res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17376shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17377 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
17378 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17379 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
17380 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
17381 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
17382 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017384res.ver : string
17385resp_ver : string (deprecated)
17386 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
17387 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017389 ACL derivatives :
17390 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017392set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17393 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17394 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017395 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017396 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017398 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
17399 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017401status : integer
17402 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
17403 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
17404 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017405
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020017406unique-id : string
17407 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
17408 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
17409 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
17410 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
17411 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
17412 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
17413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017414url : string
17415 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
17416 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
17417 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
17418 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
17419 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
17420 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
17421 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017423 ACL derivatives :
17424 url : exact string match
17425 url_beg : prefix match
17426 url_dir : subdir match
17427 url_dom : domain match
17428 url_end : suffix match
17429 url_len : length match
17430 url_reg : regex match
17431 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017433url_ip : ip
17434 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
17435 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
17436 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
17437 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
17438 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
17439 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17440 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017442url_port : integer
17443 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
17444 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
17445 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17446 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017447
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017448urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
17449url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017450 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
17451 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017452 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
17453 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
17454 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
17455 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017456 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
17457 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017458 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
17459 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017461 ACL derivatives :
17462 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
17463 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
17464 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
17465 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
17466 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
17467 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
17468 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
17469 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017470
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017472 Example :
17473 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
17474 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
17475 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
17476 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017477
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017478urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017479 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
17480 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
17481 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020017482
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020017483url32 : integer
17484 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
17485 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
17486 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
17487 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
17488 is an unsigned integer.
17489
17490url32+src : binary
17491 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
17492 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
17493 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
17494
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010017495
Christopher Fauletba3c68f2020-04-01 16:27:05 +0200174967.3.7. Fetching health-check samples
17497-------------------------------------
17498
17499This set of sample fetch methods may be called from an health-check execution
17500context. It was introduced in the version 2.2. The following sample fetches are
17501placed in the dedicated scope "check". Other sample fetches may also be called
17502when an health-check is performed if it makes sense and if the sample fetch was
17503adapted to be called in this context.
17504
17505check.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17506 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
17507 in the check input buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is
17508 zero, then the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can
17509 be called from a tcp-check expect rule, or eventually from a set-var rule
17510 after an expect rule and before a send rule (check input buffer is filled on
17511 tcp-check expect rules and reset on tcp-check send rules).
17512
17513
175147.3.8. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017515---------------------------------------
17516
17517This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
17518used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
17519purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
17520There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
17521or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
17522any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
17523for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
17524
17525internal.htx.data : integer
17526 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
17527 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17528
17529internal.htx.free : integer
17530 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
17531 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17532
17533internal.htx.free_data : integer
17534 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
17535 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17536
17537internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
17538 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
17539 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
17540 chosen depending on the sample direction.
17541
17542internal.htx.nbblks : integer
17543 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
17544 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17545
17546internal.htx.size : integer
17547 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
17548 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17549
17550internal.htx.used : integer
17551 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
17552 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17553 direction.
17554
17555internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
17556 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17557 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
17558 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
17559 of the special value :
17560 * head : The oldest inserted block
17561 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017562 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017563
17564internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
17565 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17566 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
17567 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
17568 integer or one of the special value :
17569 * head : The oldest inserted block
17570 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017571 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017572
17573internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
17574 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17575 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
17576 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17577 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17578
17579 * head : The oldest inserted block
17580 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017581 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017582
17583internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
17584 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17585 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17586 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17587 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17588
17589 * head : The oldest inserted block
17590 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017591 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017592
17593internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
17594 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17595 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17596 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17597 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17598
17599 * head : The oldest inserted block
17600 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017601 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017602
17603internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
17604 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
17605 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
17606 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17607 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17608
17609 * head : The oldest inserted block
17610 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017611 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017612
17613internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
17614 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
17615 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
17616 it returns false.
17617
17618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200176197.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017620---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017621
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017622Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
17623every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020017624order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017625
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017626ACL name Equivalent to Usage
17627---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017628FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020017629HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017630HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
17631HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017632HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
17633HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
17634HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
17635HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
17636LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017637METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017638METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017639METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
17640METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
17641METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
17642METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017643METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017644METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017645RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017646REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017647TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017648WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
17649---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017650
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010017651
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176528. Logging
17653----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017654
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017655One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
17656provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
17657very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
17658provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
17659state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017660to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017661headers.
17662
17663In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
17664about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
17665send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
17666
17667 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
17668 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
17669 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
17670 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
17671 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017672 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060017673 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017674
17675The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
17676allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
17677as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
17678while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
17679real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
17680delay.
17681
17682
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176838.1. Log levels
17684---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017685
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017686TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017687source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017688HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
17689in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
17690track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
17691syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
17692about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017693
17694
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176958.2. Log formats
17696----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017697
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017698HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017699and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
17700slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
17701options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017702
17703 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
17704 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
17705 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
17706 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
17707 extents.
17708
17709 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
17710 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
17711 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
17712 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
17713 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
17714
17715 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
17716 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
17717 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
17718 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
17719 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
17720
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020017721 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
17722 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
17723 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
17724 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
17725
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017726 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
17727
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017728Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
17729specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
17730field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
17731servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
17732always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
17733identifier.
17734
17735Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
17736 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
17737 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
17738 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
17739 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
17740
17741
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177428.2.1. Default log format
17743-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017744
17745This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
17746as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
17747format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
17748
17749 Example :
17750 listen www
17751 mode http
17752 log global
17753 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17754
17755 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
17756 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
17757 (www/HTTP)
17758
17759 Field Format Extract from the example above
17760 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
17761 2 'Connect from' Connect from
17762 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
17763 4 'to' to
17764 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
17765 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
17766
17767Detailed fields description :
17768 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
17769 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
17770 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
17771 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
17772 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17773 and processed the connection.
17774 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
17775
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017776In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
17777"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
17778connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
17779
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017780It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
17781will eventually disappear.
17782
17783
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177848.2.2. TCP log format
17785---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017786
17787The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
17788is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
17789information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
17790counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
17791emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
17792environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
17793the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
17794sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017795specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17796not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17797fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17798marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017799
17800 Example :
17801 frontend fnt
17802 mode tcp
17803 option tcplog
17804 log global
17805 default_backend bck
17806
17807 backend bck
17808 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17809
17810 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17811 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17812 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17813
17814 Field Format Extract from the example above
17815 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17816 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17817 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17818 4 frontend_name fnt
17819 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17820 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17821 7 bytes_read* 212
17822 8 termination_state --
17823 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
17824 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17825
17826Detailed fields description :
17827 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017828 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17829 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17830 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017831 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017832 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017833 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017834
17835 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017836 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17837 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17838 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017839
17840 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
17841 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
17842 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017843 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
17844 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
17845 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
17846 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017847
17848 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17849 and processed the connection.
17850
17851 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17852 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17853 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
17854 applications.
17855
17856 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17857 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17858 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17859 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
17860 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
17861
17862 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17863 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
17864 See "Timers" below for more details.
17865
17866 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17867 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
17868 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
17869 "Timers" below for more details.
17870
17871 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017872 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017873 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
17874 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
17875 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
17876 details.
17877
17878 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
17879 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
17880 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
17881 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
17882 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
17883
17884 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17885 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17886 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
17887 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
17888 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
17889 for more details.
17890
17891 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017892 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017893 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
17894 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
17895 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017896 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017897
17898 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17899 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17900 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17901 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17902 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17903 caused by a denial of service attack.
17904
17905 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17906 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17907 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17908 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17909 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17910 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17911 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17912 denial of service attack.
17913
17914 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17915 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17916 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17917 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17918 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17919 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17920 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17921 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
17922 be processed than on other servers.
17923
17924 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17925 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17926 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17927 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17928 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17929 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17930 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17931 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17932 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17933 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17934 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17935 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17936 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17937
17938 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17939 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17940 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17941 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17942 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17943 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017944 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017945 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17946
17947 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17948 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17949 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17950 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17951 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17952 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017953 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017954 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17955 occurs.
17956
17957
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179588.2.3. HTTP log format
17959----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017960
17961The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17962is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17963the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17964are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17965emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17966generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17967"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17968which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017969frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17970is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017971
17972Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17973slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17974with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17975
17976 Example :
17977 frontend http-in
17978 mode http
17979 option httplog
17980 log global
17981 default_backend bck
17982
17983 backend static
17984 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17985
17986 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17987 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17988 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017989 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017990
17991 Field Format Extract from the example above
17992 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17993 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017994 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017995 4 frontend_name http-in
17996 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017997 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017998 7 status_code 200
17999 8 bytes_read* 2750
18000 9 captured_request_cookie -
18001 10 captured_response_cookie -
18002 11 termination_state ----
18003 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
18004 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18005 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
18006 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
18007 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018008
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018009Detailed fields description :
18010 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018011 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18012 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18013 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018014 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018015 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018016 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018017
18018 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018019 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18020 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18021 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018022
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018023 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
18024 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018025
18026 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18027 and processed the connection.
18028
18029 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18030 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18031 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
18032
18033 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18034 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18035 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18036 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
18037 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
18038 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
18039
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018040 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
18041 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
18042 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018043 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018044 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
18045 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018046 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
18047 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018048
18049 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18050 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018051 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018052
18053 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18054 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018055 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
18056 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018057
18058 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
18059 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
18060 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
18061 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
18062 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018063 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
18064 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018065
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018066 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
18067 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
18068 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
18069 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
18070 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
18071 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
18072 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018073 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018074
18075 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
18076 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
18077 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
18078
18079 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
18080 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018081 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018082 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
18083 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
18084 overflowing.
18085
18086 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
18087 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
18088 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
18089 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
18090 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
18091 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
18092 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
18093 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18094
18095 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
18096 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
18097 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
18098 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
18099 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
18100 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
18101 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
18102 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18103
18104 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18105 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18106 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
18107 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
18108 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
18109 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
18110 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
18111
18112 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018113 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018114 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
18115 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
18116 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018117 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018118 system.
18119
18120 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18121 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18122 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18123 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18124 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18125 caused by a denial of service attack.
18126
18127 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18128 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18129 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18130 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18131 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18132 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18133 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18134 denial of service attack.
18135
18136 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18137 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18138 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18139 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18140 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18141 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18142 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18143 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
18144 processed than on other servers.
18145
18146 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18147 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18148 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18149 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18150 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18151 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18152 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18153 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18154 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18155 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18156 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18157 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18158 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18159
18160 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18161 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18162 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18163 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18164 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18165 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018166 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018167 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18168
18169 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18170 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18171 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18172 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18173 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18174 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018175 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018176 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18177 occurs.
18178
18179 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
18180 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
18181 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
18182 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
18183 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
18184 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
18185 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
18186 cookies" below for more details.
18187
18188 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
18189 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
18190 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
18191 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
18192 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
18193 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
18194 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
18195 and cookies" below for more details.
18196
18197 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
18198 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
18199 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
18200 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
18201 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
18202 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
18203 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
18204 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
18205
18206
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200182078.2.4. Custom log format
18208------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018209
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018210The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018211mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018212
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018213HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018214Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
18215separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
18216prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
18217
18218Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
18219variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018220("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018221
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018222If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020018223as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018224less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
18225the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
18226
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018227Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018228In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010018229in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018230
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018231Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
18232'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
18233https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
18234such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
18235
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018236Flags are :
18237 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018238 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018239 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
18240 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018241
18242 Example:
18243
18244 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
18245 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
18246
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018247 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
18248
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018249At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
18250
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018251 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
18252 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018253
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018254the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018255
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018256 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
18257 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
18258 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018259
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018260and the default TCP format is defined this way :
18261
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018262 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
18263 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018264
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018265Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
18266
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018267 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018268 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018269 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
18270 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
18271 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018272 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
18273 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
18274 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018275 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018276 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
18277 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000018278 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018279 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
18280 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010018281 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020018282 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018283 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018284 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018285 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020018286 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080018287 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018288 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
18289 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
18290 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
18291 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
18292 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018293 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018294 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018295 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018296 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018297 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018298 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
18299 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018300 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18301 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
18302 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018303 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018304 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
18305 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018306 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018307 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18308 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
18309 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020018310 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020018311 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018312 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
18313 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
18314 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
18315 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020018316 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018317 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018318 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018319 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010018320 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018321 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018322 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
18323 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
18324 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018325 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018326 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
18327 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018328 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018329 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
18330 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020018331 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018332 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018333 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018334 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018335
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018336 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018337
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018338
183398.2.5. Error log format
18340-----------------------
18341
18342When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
18343protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
18344By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
18345"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018346will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018347logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
18348
18349The format looks like this :
18350
18351 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
18352 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
18353 Connection error during SSL handshake
18354
18355 Field Format Extract from the example above
18356 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
18357 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
18358 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
18359 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
18360 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
18361
18362These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
18363failures.
18364
18365
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183668.3. Advanced logging options
18367-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018368
18369Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
18370just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
18371options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
18372for more information about their usage.
18373
18374
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183758.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
18376------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018377
18378It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
18379haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
18380commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
18381monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
18382ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
18383
18384 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
18385 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
18386 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
18387 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
18388
18389 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
18390 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
18391 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018392 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018393 such as other load-balancers.
18394
18395 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
18396 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
18397 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
18398
18399
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184008.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
18401----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018402
18403The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
18404what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
18405or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018406"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018407just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
18408log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
18409after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
18410is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
18411with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
18412with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
18413
18414
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184158.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
18416------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018417
18418Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
18419for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
18420"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
18421retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
18422raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
18423a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
18424file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
18425you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
18426"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
18427
18428
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184298.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
18430--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018431
18432Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
18433multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
18434them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
18435"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
18436logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
18437error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
18438and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
18439too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
18440useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
18441alternative.
18442
18443
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184448.4. Timing events
18445------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018446
18447Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
18448reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
18449the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
18450frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018451mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
18452addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
18453
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010018454Timings events in HTTP mode:
18455
18456 first request 2nd request
18457 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
18458 t tr t tr ...
18459 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
18460 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
18461 :<---- Tq ---->: :
18462 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018463 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010018464 :<--------- Ta --------->:
18465
18466Timings events in TCP mode:
18467
18468 TCP session
18469 |<----------------->|
18470 t t
18471 ---|----|----|----|----|---
18472 | Th Tw Tc Td |
18473 |<------ Tt ------->|
18474
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018475 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018476 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018477 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
18478 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
18479 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018480 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018481 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
18482 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
18483 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
18484 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018485
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018486 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
18487 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
18488 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018489 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
18490 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
18491 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
18492 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
18493 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
18494 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018495
18496 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
18497 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
18498 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
18499 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
18500 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
18501 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
18502 request typed by hand during a test.
18503
18504 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
18505 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018506 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018507 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
18508 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
18509 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
18510 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018511
18512 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
18513 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
18514 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
18515 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
18516 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
18517
18518 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
18519 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
18520 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
18521 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
18522 connection never established.
18523
18524 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
18525 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
18526 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
18527 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
18528 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
18529 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
18530 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
18531 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
18532 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
18533 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
18534 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
18535
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018536 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
18537 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
18538 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
18539 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
18540 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
18541 by subtracting other timers when valid :
18542
18543 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
18544
18545 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
18546 "Ta" can never be negative.
18547
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018548 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
18549 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018550 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
18551 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018552 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018553
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018554 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018555
18556 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018557 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
18558 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018559
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018560 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
18561 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
18562 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
18563 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
18564 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
18565 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
18566 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
18567 prefixed with a '+' sign.
18568
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018569These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
18570protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
18571that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018572due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
18573"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
18574that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018575
18576Most common cases :
18577
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018578 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
18579 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
18580 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
18581 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
18582 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
18583 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
18584 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
18585 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
18586 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
18587 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
18588 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020018589 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018590
18591 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
18592 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
18593 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
18594 of ms on remote networks.
18595
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018596 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
18597 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
18598 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018599
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018600 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
18601 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
18602 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
18603 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
18604 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
18605 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
18606 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
18607 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
18608 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018609
18610Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
18611
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018612 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018613 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018614 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018615
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018616 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018617 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
18618 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
18619
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018620 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018621 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
18622 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
18623 flags.
18624
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018625 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
18626 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018627 Check the session termination flags, then check the
18628 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
18629 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
18630 the client connection was maintained open.
18631
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018632 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018633 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018634 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018635 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
18636
18637
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186388.5. Session state at disconnection
18639-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018640
18641TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
18642"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
186432-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
18644each of which has a special meaning :
18645
18646 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
18647 session to terminate :
18648
18649 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
18650
18651 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
18652 server explicitly refused it.
18653
18654 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
18655 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
18656 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
18657 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018658 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018659
18660 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
18661 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018662
18663 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
18664 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
18665 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
18666 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
18667 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
18668
18669 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
18670 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
18671 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
18672 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
18673 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
18674
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090018675 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
18676 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
18677
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070018678 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
18679 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
18680 backup connections when going up.
18681
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020018682 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
18683
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018684 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
18685 send or receive data.
18686
18687 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
18688 send or receive data.
18689
18690 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
18691 with nothing left in the buffers.
18692
18693 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
18694
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010018695 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018696 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
18697
18698 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
18699 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
18700 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
18701 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
18702 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
18703
18704 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
18705 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
18706
18707 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
18708 server (HTTP only).
18709
18710 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
18711
18712 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
18713 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
18714 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
18715
18716 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
18717 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
18718 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
18719
18720 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
18721
18722 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
18723 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
18724
18725 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
18726 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
18727 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
18728
18729 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
18730 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020018731 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
18732 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018733
18734 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
18735 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
18736 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
18737 another server.
18738
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018739 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018740 server.
18741
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018742 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
18743 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
18744 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
18745 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18746
18747 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
18748 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
18749 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
18750 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18751
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020018752 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
18753 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
18754 "use-server" rule).
18755
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018756 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18757
18758 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
18759 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
18760
18761 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
18762
18763 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
18764 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
18765 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
18766
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018767 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
18768 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018769 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018770 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
18771 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
18772
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018773 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
18774
18775 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
18776 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
18777
18778 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
18779
18780 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18781
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018782The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
18783was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018784helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
18785starvation, attacks, etc...
18786
18787The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
18788alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
18789easier finding and understanding.
18790
18791 Flags Reason
18792
18793 -- Normal termination.
18794
18795 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
18796 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
18797 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
18798 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
18799
18800 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
18801 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
18802 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
18803 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
18804 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
18805 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018806
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018807 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18808 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018809 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018810
18811 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18812 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18813 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18814
18815 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18816 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18817 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18818 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18819 the server takes too long to respond.
18820
18821 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18822 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18823 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
18824 long a time to respond.
18825
18826 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
18827 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
18828 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
18829 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018830 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
18831 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018832
18833 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
18834 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
18835 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
18836 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
18837 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020018838 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018839 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
18840 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
18841 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
18842 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
18843 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
18844 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
18845 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
18846 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018847 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018848 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
18849 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
18850 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018851
18852 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
18853 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018854 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
18855 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
18856 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
18857 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018858
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018859 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
18860 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
18861
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018862 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018863 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
18864 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018865 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018866 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
18867 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
18868
18869 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
18870 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
18871 503 or 504 here.
18872
18873 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
18874 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
18875 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
18876 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
18877 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
18878
18879 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18880 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018881 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018882 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
18883 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
18884
18885 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
18886 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
18887 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
18888 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
18889 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
18890 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
18891 between haproxy and the server.
18892
18893 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
18894 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
18895 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
18896 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
18897 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
18898 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
18899 solution is to fix the application.
18900
18901 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
18902 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
18903 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
18904 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
18905 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
18906 external attacks.
18907
18908 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
18909 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018910 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018911 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
18912 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
18913
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018914 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
18915 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
18916 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018917 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020018918 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018919
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018920 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
18921 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
18922 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
18923 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018924 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
18925 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
18926 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
18927 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
18928 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018929
18930 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
18931 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
18932 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
18933 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18934
18935 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18936 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18937 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18938 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18939
18940 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18941 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18942 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18943 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18944
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018945The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18946persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18947important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18948re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18949
18950 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18951
18952 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18953 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18954 set on a GET request.
18955
18956 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18957 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018958 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018959 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18960
18961 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18962 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18963 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18964
18965 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18966 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18967 already got a cookie.
18968
18969 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18970 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18971 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18972 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18973 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18974
18975 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18976 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18977 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18978
18979 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18980 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18981 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18982
18983 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18984 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18985
18986 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18987 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18988 then advertised in the response.
18989
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018990
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189918.6. Non-printable characters
18992-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018993
18994In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18995consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18996converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18997prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18998being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18999escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
19000is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
19001'}' when logging headers.
19002
19003Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
19004issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
19005containing spaces is "User-Agent".
19006
19007Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
19008the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
19009performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
19010
19011
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
19013---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019014
19015Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
19016achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019017section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019018cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
19019the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
19020the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019021locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019022not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
19023user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
19024a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
19025wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
19026
19027 Examples :
19028 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
19029 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
19030
19031 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
19032 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
19033
19034
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190358.8. Capturing HTTP headers
19036---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019037
19038Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
19039proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
19040the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
19041server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
19042
19043Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
19044response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019045section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019046
19047It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019048time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
19049appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019050are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
19051and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
19052follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
19053request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
19054in the logs.
19055
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019056As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
19057frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
19058an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
19059
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019060 Example :
19061 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
19062 listen proxy-out
19063 mode http
19064 option httplog
19065 option logasap
19066 log global
19067 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
19068
19069 # log the name of the virtual server
19070 capture request header Host len 20
19071
19072 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
19073 capture request header Content-Length len 10
19074
19075 # log the beginning of the referrer
19076 capture request header Referer len 20
19077
19078 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
19079 capture response header Server len 20
19080
19081 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
19082 capture response header Content-Length len 10
19083
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019084 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019085 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
19086
19087 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
19088 capture response header Via len 20
19089
19090 # log the URL location during a redirection
19091 capture response header Location len 20
19092
19093 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
19094 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
19095 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19096 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
19097 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
19098
19099 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19100 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19101 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19102 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019103 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019104
19105 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19106 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19107 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19108 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
19109 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019110 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019111
19112
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191138.9. Examples of logs
19114---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019115
19116These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
19117them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
19118reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
19119
19120 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
19121 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19122 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19123
19124 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
19125 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
19126
19127 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
19128 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
19129 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19130
19131 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
19132 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
19133
19134 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
19135 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19136 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
19137
19138 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019139 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019140 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
19141 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
19142
19143 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
19144 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
19145 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
19146
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020019147 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
19148 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
19149 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
19150 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
19151 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
19152 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019153
19154 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019155 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019156
19157 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
19158 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
19159 Nothing was sent to any server.
19160
19161 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
19162 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
19163
19164 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
19165 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019166 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019167 send a 408 return code to the client.
19168
19169 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
19170 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
19171
19172 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
19173 5 seconds ("c----").
19174
19175 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
19176 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019177 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019178
19179 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019180 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019181 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
19182 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
19183 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
19184 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
19185 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019186
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020019187
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200191889. Supported filters
19189--------------------
19190
19191Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
19192accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
19193unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
19194
19195See also : "filter"
19196
191979.1. Trace
19198----------
19199
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019200filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019201
19202 Arguments:
19203 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
19204 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
19205
19206 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
19207 the client and the server. By default, this filter
19208 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
19209 only parses a random amount of the available data.
19210
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019211 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019212 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
19213 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
19214 amount of the parsed data.
19215
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019216 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019217
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019218This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
19219callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
19220information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
19221filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
19222
19223Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
19224tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
19225a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
19226
19227
192289.2. HTTP compression
19229---------------------
19230
19231filter compression
19232
19233The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
19234keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019235when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
19236fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
19237done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
19238explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
19239filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
19240listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19241order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019242
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019243See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
19244 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019245
19246
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200192479.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
19248--------------------------------------------
19249
19250filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
19251
19252 Arguments :
19253
19254 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
19255 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
19256 parsed.
19257
19258 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
19259 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
19260 part must be placed in its own scope.
19261
19262The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
19263external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019264streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019265exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
19266also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
19267
19268SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
19269the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
19270
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019271For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019272"doc/SPOE.txt".
19273
19274Important note:
19275 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
19276 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
19277
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100192789.4. Cache
19279----------
19280
19281filter cache <name>
19282
19283 Arguments :
19284
19285 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
19286
19287The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
19288"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019289cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019290other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
19291case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
19292is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
19293filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010019294listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19295order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010019296
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019297See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
19298 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
19299
19300
193019.5. Fcgi-app
19302-------------
19303
19304filter fcg-app <name>
19305
19306 Arguments :
19307
19308 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
19309
19310The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
19311request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
19312reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
19313used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
19314implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
19315used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
19316fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
19317used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19318order.
19319
19320See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
19321 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
19322
19323
1932410. FastCGI applications
19325-------------------------
19326
19327HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
19328feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
19329the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
19330FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
19331servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
19332FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
19333backend.
19334
19335HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
19336application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
19337connection.
19338
1933910.1. Setup
19340-----------
19341
1934210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
19343--------------------------
19344
19345fcgi-app <name>
19346 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
19347 document root must be defined.
19348
19349acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
19350 Declare or complete an access list.
19351
19352 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
19353 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
19354 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
19355 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
19356 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
19357
19358docroot <path>
19359 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
19360 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
19361 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
19362
19363index <script-name>
19364 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
19365 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
19366 is an optional setting.
19367
19368 Example :
19369 index index.php
19370
19371log-stderr global
19372log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
19373 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
19374 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
19375
19376 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
19377 default STDERR messages are ignored.
19378
19379pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19380 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
19381 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
19382 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19383
19384 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
19385 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
19386 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
19387 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
19388
19389 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
19390 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
19391
19392path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019393 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019394 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
19395 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
19396 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
19397 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
19398 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
19399 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
19400 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019401
19402 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019403 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019404 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
19405 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
19406 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
19407 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019408
19409 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019410 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
19411 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019412
19413option get-values
19414no option get-values
19415 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
19416
19417 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
19418 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
19419
19420 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
19421 application will accept.
19422
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020019423 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
19424 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019425
19426 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
19427 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
19428 option is disabled.
19429
19430 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
19431 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
19432 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
19433 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
19434 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
19435 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
19436
19437option keep-conn
19438no option keep-conn
19439 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
19440 sending a response.
19441
19442 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
19443 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
19444
19445option max-reqs <reqs>
19446 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
19447 accept.
19448
19449 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
19450 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
19451 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
19452 to 1.
19453
19454option mpxs-conns
19455no option mpxs-conns
19456 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
19457
19458 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
19459 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
19460
19461set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19462 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
19463 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
19464 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
19465 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19466
19467 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
19468 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
19469 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
19470
19471 Example :
19472 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
19473 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
19474
19475 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
19476
19477
1947810.1.2. Proxy section
19479---------------------
19480
19481use-fcgi-app <name>
19482 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
19483
19484 Arguments :
19485 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
19486
19487 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
19488 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
19489 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
19490 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
19491 application may be defined at a time per backend.
19492
19493 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
19494 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
19495 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
19496 application are evaluated.
19497
19498
1949910.1.3. Example
19500---------------
19501
19502 frontend front-http
19503 mode http
19504 bind *:80
19505 bind *:
19506
19507 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
19508 default_backend back-static
19509
19510 backend back-static
19511 mode http
19512 server www A.B.C.D:80
19513
19514 backend back-dynamic
19515 mode http
19516 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
19517 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
19518
19519 fcgi-app php-fpm
19520 log-stderr global
19521 option keep-conn
19522
19523 docroot /var/www/my-app
19524 index index.php
19525 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
19526
19527
1952810.2. Default parameters
19529------------------------
19530
19531A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
19532the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019533script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019534applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
19535
19536 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19537 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
19538 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
19539 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
19540 | | |
19541 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19542 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
19543 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
19544 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
19545 | | application. |
19546 | | |
19547 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19548 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
19549 | | the request. It may not be set. |
19550 | | |
19551 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19552 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
19553 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
19554 | | the application's configuration. |
19555 | | |
19556 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19557 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
19558 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
19559 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
19560 | | |
19561 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19562 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
19563 | | following the part that identifies the script |
19564 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
19565 | | be defined. |
19566 | | |
19567 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19568 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
19569 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
19570 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
19571 | | is not set too. |
19572 | | |
19573 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19574 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
19575 | | set. |
19576 | | |
19577 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19578 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
19579 | | the request. |
19580 | | |
19581 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19582 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
19583 | | client as part of user authentication. |
19584 | | |
19585 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19586 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
19587 | | script to process the request. |
19588 | | |
19589 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19590 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
19591 | | |
19592 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19593 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
19594 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
19595 | | |
19596 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19597 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
19598 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
19599 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
19600 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
19601 | | |
19602 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19603 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
19604 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
19605 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
19606 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
19607 | | side. |
19608 | | |
19609 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19610 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
19611 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
19612 | | connected to. |
19613 | | |
19614 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19615 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
19616 | | |
19617 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19618 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
19619 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
19620 | | |
19621 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19622
19623
1962410.3. Limitations
19625------------------
19626
19627The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
19628way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
19629during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
19630establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
19631application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
19632or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
19633message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
19634these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
19635and HTTP servers under the same backend.
19636
19637Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
19638request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
19639requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
19640
19641About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
19642into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
19643fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
19644"http-request" ones.
19645
19646Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
19647FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
19648processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
19649must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
19650here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010019651
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019652/*
19653 * Local variables:
19654 * fill-column: 79
19655 * End:
19656 */